blob: 95b1dc090626bfc09e12fe36422c9f4779da7c15 [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewyckye1121512013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Benjamin Kramerf3ca26982014-05-10 16:31:55 +000023#include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000024#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
David Majnemerc729b0b2013-09-16 22:44:20 +000025#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000026#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
30#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +000034#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000035#include <algorithm>
David Blaikie8ad22e62014-05-01 23:01:41 +000036#include <cstdlib>
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000037
38namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000039using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000040
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000042static ExprResult
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000043CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
44 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +000045 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
46 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000047 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
Faisal Valid6676412013-06-15 11:54:37 +000048 return ExprError();
49 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
50 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
51 // called on both.
52 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
53 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
54 // being used.
55 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000056 return ExprError();
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +000057 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000058 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
59 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
60 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000061
62 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000063
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000064 ExprResult E = DRE;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000065 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.get());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000066 if (E.isInvalid())
67 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer62b95d82012-08-23 21:35:17 +000068 return E;
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000069}
70
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000071static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
72 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000073 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +000074 bool CStyle,
75 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzer04390a62012-08-16 02:38:47 +000076
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000077static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
78 QualType &ToType,
79 bool InOverloadResolution,
80 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
81 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000082static OverloadingResult
83IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
84 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
85 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +000086 bool AllowExplicit,
87 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000088
89
90static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
91CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
92 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
93 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
94
95static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
96CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
97 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
98 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
99
100static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
101CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
102 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
104
105
106
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000107/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
108/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000109ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000110GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
111 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
112 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
113 ICC_Identity,
114 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
115 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
116 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000117 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000118 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
119 ICC_Promotion,
120 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000121 ICC_Promotion,
122 ICC_Conversion,
123 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000124 ICC_Conversion,
125 ICC_Conversion,
126 ICC_Conversion,
127 ICC_Conversion,
128 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000129 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000130 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000131 ICC_Conversion,
132 ICC_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000133 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000134 ICC_Conversion
135 };
136 return Category[(int)Kind];
137}
138
139/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
140/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
141ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
142 static const ImplicitConversionRank
143 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
144 ICR_Exact_Match,
145 ICR_Exact_Match,
146 ICR_Exact_Match,
147 ICR_Exact_Match,
148 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000149 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 ICR_Promotion,
151 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000152 ICR_Promotion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
154 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 ICR_Conversion,
156 ICR_Conversion,
157 ICR_Conversion,
158 ICR_Conversion,
159 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000160 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000161 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000162 ICR_Conversion,
163 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000164 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
165 ICR_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000166 ICR_Conversion,
167 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000168 };
169 return Rank[(int)Kind];
170}
171
172/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
173/// implicit conversion.
174const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000175 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000176 "No conversion",
177 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
178 "Array-to-pointer",
179 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000180 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000181 "Qualification",
182 "Integral promotion",
183 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000184 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000185 "Integral conversion",
186 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000187 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000188 "Floating-integral conversion",
189 "Pointer conversion",
190 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000191 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000192 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000193 "Derived-to-base conversion",
194 "Vector conversion",
195 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000196 "Complex-real conversion",
197 "Block Pointer conversion",
198 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000199 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000200 };
201 return Name[Kind];
202}
203
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000204/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
205/// sequence to the identity conversion.
206void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
207 First = ICK_Identity;
208 Second = ICK_Identity;
209 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000210 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000211 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000212 ReferenceBinding = false;
213 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000214 IsLvalueReference = true;
215 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
216 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000217 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000218 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000219 CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000220}
221
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000222/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
223/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
224/// implicit conversions.
225ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
226 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
227 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
228 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
229 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
230 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
231 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
232 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
233 return Rank;
234}
235
236/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
237/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000239/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000240bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000241 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
242 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
243 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
244 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000245 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000246 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
247 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
248 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000249 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000250 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
251 return true;
252
253 return false;
254}
255
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000256/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
257/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
258/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
259/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000260bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000261StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000262isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000263 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000264 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000265
266 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
267 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
268 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
269 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
270 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
271
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000272 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000273 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000274 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
275
276 return false;
277}
278
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000279/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
280/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
281static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
282 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
283 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
284 case CK_NoOp:
285 case CK_IntegralCast:
286 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
287 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
288 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
289 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
290 case CK_FloatingCast:
291 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
292 continue;
293
294 default:
295 return Converted;
296 }
297 }
298
299 return Converted;
300}
301
302/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
303/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
304///
305/// \param Ctx The AST context.
306/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
307/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000309/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
310/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000311NarrowingKind
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000312StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
313 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000314 APValue &ConstantValue,
315 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000316 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000317
318 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
319 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
320 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
321 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
322 switch (Second) {
323 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
324 //
325 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
326 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
327 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
328 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
329 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
330 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
331 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
332 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
333 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
334 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
335 if (Initializer &&
336 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
337 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
338 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
339 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
340 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
341 // And back.
342 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
343 bool ignored;
344 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
345 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
346 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
347 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
348 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000349 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000350 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
351 }
352 } else {
353 // Variables are always narrowings.
354 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
355 }
356 }
357 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
358
359 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
360 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
361 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
362 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
363 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
364 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
365 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
366 // FromType is larger than ToType.
367 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
368 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
369 // Constant!
370 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
371 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
372 // Convert the source value into the target type.
373 bool ignored;
374 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
375 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
376 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
377 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
378 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000379 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
380 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000381 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000382 }
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000383 } else {
384 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
385 }
386 }
387 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
388
389 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
390 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
391 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
392 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
393 // value when converted back to the original type.
394 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
395 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
396 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
397 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
398 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
399 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
400 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
401 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
402 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
403 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
404 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
405 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
406 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
407
408 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000409 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
410 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000411 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
412 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
413 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000414 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
415 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
416 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith72cd8ea2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000417 }
418 bool Narrowing = false;
419 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000420 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
421 // narrowing.
422 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith72cd8ea2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000423 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000424 } else {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000425 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
426 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
427 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
428 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
429 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
430 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
431 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
432 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
433 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
434 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
435 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith72cd8ea2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000436 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
437 Narrowing = true;
438 }
439 if (Narrowing) {
440 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
441 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
442 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000443 }
444 }
445 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
446 }
447
448 default:
449 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
450 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
451 }
452}
453
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000454/// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000456void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000457 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000458 bool PrintedSomething = false;
459 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000460 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000461 PrintedSomething = true;
462 }
463
464 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
465 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000466 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000467 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000468 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000469
470 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000471 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000472 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000473 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000474 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000475 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000476 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000477 PrintedSomething = true;
478 }
479
480 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
481 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000482 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000483 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000484 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000485 PrintedSomething = true;
486 }
487
488 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000489 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000490 }
491}
492
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000493/// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000494/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000495void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000496 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000498 Before.dump();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000499 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000500 }
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000501 if (ConversionFunction)
502 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
503 else
504 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000505 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000506 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000507 After.dump();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000508 }
509}
510
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000511/// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000512/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000513void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000514 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +0000515 if (isStdInitializerListElement())
516 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000517 switch (ConversionKind) {
518 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000519 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000520 Standard.dump();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000521 break;
522 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000523 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000524 UserDefined.dump();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000525 break;
526 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000527 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000528 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000529 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000530 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000531 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000532 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000533 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000534 break;
535 }
536
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000537 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000538}
539
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000540void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
541 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
542}
543
544void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
545 conversions().~ConversionSet();
546}
547
548void
549AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
550 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
551 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
552 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
553}
554
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555namespace {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000556 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000557 // template argument information.
558 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000559 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
560 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
561 };
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000562 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000563 // template parameter and template argument information.
564 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
565 TemplateParameter Param;
566 };
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000567}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000568
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000569/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
570/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000571DeductionFailureInfo MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
572 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
573 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
574 DeductionFailureInfo Result;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000575 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000576 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000577 Result.Data = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000578 switch (TDK) {
579 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000580 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000581 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000582 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
583 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000584 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000585
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000586 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000587 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000588 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
589 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000590
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000591 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
592 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
593 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
594 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
595 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
596 Result.Data = Saved;
597 break;
598 }
599
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000600 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000601 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000602 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
603 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000604 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
605 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
606 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
607 Result.Data = Saved;
608 break;
609 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000610
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000611 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000612 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000613 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
614 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
615 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
616 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
617 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
618 }
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000619 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000620
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000621 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000622 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
623 break;
624
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000626 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000627 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000628
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000629 return Result;
630}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000631
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000632void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000633 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
634 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000635 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000636 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
637 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000638 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
639 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000640 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000641 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000642 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000643
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000644 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000645 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000647 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000648 Data = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000649 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000650
651 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000652 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000653 Data = nullptr;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000654 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
655 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
656 HasDiagnostic = false;
657 }
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000658 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000659
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000660 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000661 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000662 break;
663 }
664}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000665
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000666PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000667 if (HasDiagnostic)
668 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000669 return nullptr;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000670}
671
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000672TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
674 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000675 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000676 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000677 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
678 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000679 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000680 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
681 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000682 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000683
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000685 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000686 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000687
688 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000689 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000690 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000691
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000692 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000693 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000694 break;
695 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000696
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000697 return TemplateParameter();
698}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000699
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000700TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000701 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000702 case Sema::TDK_Success:
703 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
704 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
705 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
706 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
707 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
708 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
709 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
710 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
711 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
712 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000713 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000714
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000715 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
716 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000717
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000718 // Unhandled
719 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
720 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000721 }
722
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000723 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000724}
725
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000726const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000727 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
728 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000730 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
731 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000732 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
733 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000734 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000736 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000737 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000738
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000739 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000740 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000741 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
742 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000743
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000744 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000745 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000746 break;
747 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000748
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000749 return nullptr;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000750}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000751
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000752const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000753 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
754 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000755 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
757 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
759 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000760 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000761 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000762 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000763 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000764
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000765 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000766 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000767 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
768 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000769
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000770 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000771 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000772 break;
773 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000774
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000775 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000776}
777
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000778Expr *DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000779 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
780 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
781 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
782
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000783 return nullptr;
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000784}
785
Benjamin Kramer97e59492012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000786void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smith0bf93aa2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000787 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer02b08432012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000788 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
789 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smith0bf93aa2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000790 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
791 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
792 }
Benjamin Kramer97e59492012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000793}
794
795void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
796 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer0b9c5092012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000797 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000798 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000799 Functions.clear();
800}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000801
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000802namespace {
803 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
804 struct Entry {
805 Expr **Addr;
806 Expr *Saved;
807 };
808 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
809
810 public:
811 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
812 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
813 Entry entry = { &E, E };
814 Entries.push_back(entry);
815 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
816 }
817
818 void restore() {
819 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
820 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
821 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
822 }
823 };
824}
825
826/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
827/// preprocessing on the given expression.
828///
829/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
830/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
831///
832/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000833static bool
834checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
835 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000836 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
837 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
838 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
839 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
840
841 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
842 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
843 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
844 unbridgedCasts) {
845 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 // Go ahead and check everything else.
850 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
851 if (result.isInvalid())
852 return true;
853
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +0000854 E = result.get();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000855 return false;
856 }
857
858 // Nothing to do.
859 return false;
860}
861
862/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
863/// placeholders.
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000864static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
865 MultiExprArg Args,
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000866 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000867 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
868 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000869 return true;
870
871 return false;
872}
873
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000874// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000875// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
876// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
877// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
878// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000879// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
880// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
881// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000882//
883// Example: Given the following input:
884//
885// void f(int, float); // #1
886// void f(int, int); // #2
887// int f(int, int); // #3
888//
889// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000891//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000892// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
893// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
894// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
895// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000896//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000897// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
898// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
899// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
900// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000901// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
902// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000903//
904// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
905// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
906// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
907// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000908Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000909Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
910 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000911 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000912 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000913 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
914
915 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
916 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
917 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
918
919 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
920 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
921 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
922
923 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
924 }
925
926 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
927 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
928 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
929 // function templates hide function templates with different
930 // return types or template parameter lists.
931 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
John McCallc70fca62013-04-03 21:19:47 +0000932 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
933 !New->getFriendObjectKind();
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934
Alp Tokera2794f92014-01-22 07:29:52 +0000935 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000936 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939 continue;
940 }
941
Alp Tokera2794f92014-01-22 07:29:52 +0000942 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
943 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
Rafael Espindola5bddd6a2013-04-15 12:49:13 +0000944 continue;
945
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000946 Match = *I;
947 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000948 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000949 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000950 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
951 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
952 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000953 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
954 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000955 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
956 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
957 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
958 // template instantiation.
959 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000960 // (C++ 13p1):
961 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
962 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000963 Match = *I;
964 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000965 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000966 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000967
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000968 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000969}
970
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +0000971bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
972 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
973 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
974 if (New->isMain())
Rafael Espindola576127d2012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000975 return false;
Rafael Espindola7cf35ef2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000976
David Majnemerc729b0b2013-09-16 22:44:20 +0000977 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
978 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
979 return false;
980
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000981 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
982 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
983
984 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
985 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
986 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000987 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000988 return true;
989
990 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +0000991 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
992 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000993
994 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
995 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
996 // in the signature, they are overloads.
997
998 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
999 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1000 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1001 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1002 return false;
1003
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00001004 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1005 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001006
1007 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1008 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1009 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1010 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00001011 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001012 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00001013 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001014 return true;
1015
1016 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1017 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1018 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1019 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1020 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1021 // signature.
1022 //
1023 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1024 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001025 //
1026 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1027 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1028 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001029 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1030 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1031 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00001032 OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType()))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001033 return true;
1034
1035 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001036 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001037 //
1038 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1039 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1040 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1041 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1042 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001043 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1044 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001045 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001046 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1047 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1048 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1049 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1050 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1051 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1052 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1053 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1054 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1055 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1056 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001057 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001058 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001059 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001060 }
1061 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001062 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001063
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001064 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1065 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1066 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1067 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
David Majnemer42350df2013-11-03 23:51:28 +00001068 unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001069 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00001070 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
Richard Smithe83b1d32013-06-25 18:46:26 +00001071 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001072 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
David Majnemer42350df2013-11-03 23:51:28 +00001073
1074 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1075 OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1076 NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1077 if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001078 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001079 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001080
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00001081 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1082 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1083 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1084 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1085 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1086 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1087 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1088 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1089 return true;
1090 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1091 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1092 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
Nick Lewyckyd950ae72014-01-21 01:30:30 +00001093 if (NewID != OldID)
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00001094 return true;
1095 }
1096
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001097 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1098 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001099}
1100
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001101/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1102/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1103///
1104/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1105/// an available function, false otherwise.
1106bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1107 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1108}
1109
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001110/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1111///
1112/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1113/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1114static ImplicitConversionSequence
1115TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1116 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1117 bool AllowExplicit,
1118 bool InOverloadResolution,
1119 bool CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001120 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1121 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001122 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1123
1124 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1125 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1126 // we can perform.
1127 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1128 return ICS;
1129 }
1130
1131 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00001132 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1133 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001134 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1135 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001136 AllowExplicit, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001137
1138 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1139 ICS.setUserDefined();
Ismail Pazarbasidf1a2802014-01-24 13:16:17 +00001140 ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001141 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1142 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1143 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1144 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1145 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1146 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1147 // called for those cases.
1148 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1149 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1150 QualType FromCanon
1151 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1152 QualType ToCanon
1153 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1154 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1155 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1156 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1157 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1158 ICS.setStandard();
1159 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1160 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1161 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1162 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1163 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1164 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1165 }
1166 }
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001167 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1168 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1169 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1170 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1171 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1172 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1173 if (Cand->Viable)
1174 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1175 } else {
1176 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1177 }
1178
1179 return ICS;
1180}
1181
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001182/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1183/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1184/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1185/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001186///
1187/// void f(float f);
1188/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1189///
1190/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1191/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1192/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1193/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1194//
1195/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1196/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1197/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1198/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1199/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001200///
1201/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1202/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001203/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1204/// permitted.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001205///
1206/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1207/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1208/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209static ImplicitConversionSequence
1210TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1211 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001212 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001213 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001214 bool CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001215 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1216 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001217 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001218 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001219 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001220 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001221 return ICS;
1222 }
1223
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001224 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001225 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001226 return ICS;
1227 }
1228
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001229 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1230 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1231 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1232 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1233 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1234 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1235 // called for those cases.
1236 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1237 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001238 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1239 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001240 ICS.setStandard();
1241 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1242 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1243 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001244
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001245 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1246 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1247 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1248 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00001249 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001250
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001251 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001252 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001253 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001254
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001255 return ICS;
1256 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001257
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001258 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1259 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001260 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1261 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001262}
1263
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001264ImplicitConversionSequence
1265Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1266 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1267 bool AllowExplicit,
1268 bool InOverloadResolution,
1269 bool CStyle,
1270 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1271 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1272 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1273 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001274 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1275 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001276}
1277
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001278/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001279/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001280/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1281/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1282/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001283ExprResult
1284Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001285 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001286 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001287 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001288}
1289
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001290ExprResult
1291Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001292 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001293 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001294 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1295 return ExprError();
1296
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001297 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1298 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001299 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
Fariborz Jahanian381edf52013-12-16 22:54:37 +00001301 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1)
1302 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(),
1303 ToType, From->getType(), From);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001304 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1305 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1306 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001307 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001308 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001309 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1310 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001311 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1312}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001313
1314/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001315/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001316bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1317 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001318 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1319 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001320
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001321 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1322 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1323 // - a pointer
1324 // - a member pointer
1325 // - a block pointer
1326 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1327 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1328 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1329 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1330 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1331 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1332 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1333 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1334 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1335 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1336 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1337 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1338 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1339 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1340 } else {
1341 return false;
1342 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001343
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001344 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1345 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1346 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1347 return false;
1348 }
1349
1350 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1351 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1352 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1353
1354 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1355 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1356 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1357
1358 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001359 return true;
1360}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001361
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001362/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1363/// vector conversion.
1364///
1365/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1366/// conversion.
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001367static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001368 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001369 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1370 // conversion.
1371 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1372 return false;
1373
1374 // Identical types require no conversions.
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001375 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001376 return false;
1377
1378 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1379 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1380 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1381 // identity conversion.
1382 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1383 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001384
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001385 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001386 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001387 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1388 return true;
1389 }
1390 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001391
1392 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1393 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1394 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1395 // same size
1396 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001397 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1398 S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001399 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1400 return true;
1401 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001402 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001403
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001404 return false;
1405}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001406
Douglas Gregorf9e36cc2012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001407static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1408 bool InOverloadResolution,
1409 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1410 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001411
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001412/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1413/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1414/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1415/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1416/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1417/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1418/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1419/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001420static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1421 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001422 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001423 bool CStyle,
1424 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001426
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001427 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001428 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001429 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001430 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00001431 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001432
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001433 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001434 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001435 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001436 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001437 return false;
1438
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001440 }
1441
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001442 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1443 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1444 // (C++ 4p1).
1445
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001446 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001447 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1448 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001449 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001450 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001451 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1452 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1453 FromType = Fn->getType();
Ehsan Akhgaric3ad3ba2014-07-22 20:20:14 +00001454 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001455
1456 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1457 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1458 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1459 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1460 QualType resultTy;
1461 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001462 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001463 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1464 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1465 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1466 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001467 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001468
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001469 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1470 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1471 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1472 // expression.
1473 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1474 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1475 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1476 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1477 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1478 == UO_AddrOf &&
1479 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1480 const Type *ClassType
1481 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1482 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001483 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1484 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1485 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001486 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1487 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1488 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001489
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001490 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001491 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1492 FromType,
1493 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001494 } else {
1495 return false;
1496 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001497 }
John McCall154a2fd2011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001498 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1499 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1500 // be converted to a prvalue.
1501 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001502 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001503 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001504 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001505 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001506
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001507 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1508 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1509 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1510 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1511 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1512
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001513 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1514 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001515 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1516 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001517 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001518 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1519 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001520 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001521
1522 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1523 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1524 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001525 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001526
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001527 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00001528 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001529 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001530
1531 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1532 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1533 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1534 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001535 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1536 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001537 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001538 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001539 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001540 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001541 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001542 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001543 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001544
1545 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1546 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1547 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001548 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001549 } else {
1550 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001551 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001552 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001553 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001554
1555 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1556 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1557 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1558 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001559 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1560 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001561 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001562 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001563 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001564 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1565 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001566 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001567 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001568 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001569 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001570 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001571 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001572 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001573 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001574 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001575 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001576 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001577 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1578 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001579 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1580 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1581 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1582 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1583 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1584 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1585 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1586 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1587 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001588 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001589 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001590 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001591 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001592 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Richard Smithb8a98242013-05-10 20:29:50 +00001593 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001594 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001595 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1596 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001597 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1598 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001599 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1600 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1601 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001602 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001603 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1604 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1605 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001606 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001607 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001608 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001609 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001610 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001611 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001612 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001613 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001614 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1615 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1616 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1617 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001618 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1619 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001620 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001621 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001622 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001623 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001624 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001625 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001626 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001627 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001628 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001629 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1630 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001631 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001632 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001633 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001634 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001635 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001636 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001637 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1638 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001639 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1640 InOverloadResolution,
1641 SCS, CStyle)) {
1642 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1643 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregorf9e36cc2012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001644 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1645 CStyle)) {
1646 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001647 // appropriately.
1648 return true;
Guy Benyei259f9f42013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001649 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1650 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1651 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1652 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1653 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001654 } else {
1655 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001656 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001657 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001658 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001659
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001660 QualType CanonFrom;
1661 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001662 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001663 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1664 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1665 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001666 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001667 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001668 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001669 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1670 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001671 } else {
1672 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001673 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1674
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001675 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001676 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1677 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1678 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001679 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1680 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001681 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001682 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Matt Arsenault7d36c012013-02-26 21:15:54 +00001683 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001684 FromType = ToType;
1685 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1686 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001687 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001688 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001689
1690 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1691 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001692 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001693 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001694
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001695 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001696}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001697
1698static bool
1699IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1700 QualType &ToType,
1701 bool InOverloadResolution,
1702 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1703 bool CStyle) {
1704
1705 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1706 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1707 return false;
1708 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1709 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1710 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00001711 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001712 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1713 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001714 ToType = it->getType();
1715 return true;
1716 }
1717 }
1718 return false;
1719}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001720
1721/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1722/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1723/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1724/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001725bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001726 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001727 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001728 if (!To) {
1729 return false;
1730 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001731
1732 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1733 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1734 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1735 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1736 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001737 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1738 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001739 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1740 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1741 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1742 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001743 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001744 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001745 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001746 }
1747
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001748 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1749 }
1750
Richard Smithb9c5a602012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001751 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001752 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1753 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1754 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1755 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1756 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001757 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001758 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001759 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001760 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1761 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001762 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithb9c5a602012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001763 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1764 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1765 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1766 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1767 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1768 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001769 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1770 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1771 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1772 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1773 return false;
1774
Richard Smithb9c5a602012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001775 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1776 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1777 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1778 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1779 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1780 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1781 }
1782
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001783 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001785 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001786 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1787 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001788 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001789
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001790 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001791 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1792 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1793 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001794 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001795 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001796 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001797 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001798 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001799 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001800 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001801 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1802 // unsigned.
David Majnemerfa01a582011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001803 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001804 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001805
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001806 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1807 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001808 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1809 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001810 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1811 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001812 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001813 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001814 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1815 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001816 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001817 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1818 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1819 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1820 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001821 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001822 }
1823 }
1824 }
1825
1826 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1827 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1828 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1829 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1830 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1831 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1832 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001833 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1834 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001835 using llvm::APSInt;
1836 if (From)
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00001837 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001838 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001839 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001840 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1841 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1842 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001843
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001844 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1845 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1846 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1847 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1848 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001849
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001850 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1851 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1852 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1853 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1854 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001855
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001856 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001857 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001858 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001859
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001860 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1861 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001862 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001863 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001864 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001865
1866 return false;
1867}
1868
1869/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1870/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1871/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001872bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001873 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1874 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001875 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1876 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001877 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1878 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1879 return true;
1880
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001881 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1882 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1883 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001884 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001885 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1886 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1887 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1888 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001889
1890 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001891 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1892 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001893 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1894 return true;
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001895 }
1896
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001897 return false;
1898}
1899
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001900/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1901///
1902/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1903/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001904/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001905bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001906 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001907 if (!FromComplex)
1908 return false;
1909
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001910 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001911 if (!ToComplex)
1912 return false;
1913
1914 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001915 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00001916 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001917 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001918}
1919
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001920/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1921/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1922/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1923/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1924/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001925///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001926static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001927BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001928 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001929 ASTContext &Context,
1930 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001931 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1932 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1933 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001934
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001935 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1936 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001937 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001938
1939 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001940 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001941 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001942 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001943
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001944 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1945 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1946
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001947 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001948 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001949 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001950 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001951 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001952
1953 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1954 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001955 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1956 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001957 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1958 }
1959
1960 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001961 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1962 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001963
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001964 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1965 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1966 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001967}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001968
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001969static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001970 bool InOverloadResolution,
1971 ASTContext &Context) {
1972 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1973 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1974 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001975 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001976 return !InOverloadResolution;
1977
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001978 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1979 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1980 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001981}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001982
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001983/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1984/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1985/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1986/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1987/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1988/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001989///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001990/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1991/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1992/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1993/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1994/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1995/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001996/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1997/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1998/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001999bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00002000 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002001 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002002 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002003 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002004 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2005 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002006 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002007
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002008 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2009 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002010 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002011 ConvertedType = ToType;
2012 return true;
2013 }
2014
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002015 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2016 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002017 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002018 ConvertedType = ToType;
2019 return true;
2020 }
2021 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2022 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002023 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002024 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002025 ConvertedType = ToType;
2026 return true;
2027 }
2028
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002029 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2030 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002031 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002032 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002033 ConvertedType = ToType;
2034 return true;
2035 }
2036
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002037 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002038 if (!ToTypePtr)
2039 return false;
2040
2041 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002042 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002043 ConvertedType = ToType;
2044 return true;
2045 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002046
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002047 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002048 // , including objective-c pointers.
2049 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002050 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002051 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002052 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2053 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2054 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002055 ToType, Context);
2056 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002057 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002058 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002059 if (!FromTypePtr)
2060 return false;
2061
2062 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002063
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002064 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002065 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2066 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2067 return false;
2068
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002069 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2070 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2071 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002072 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2073 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002074 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002075 ToPointeeType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002076 ToType, Context,
2077 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002078 return true;
2079 }
2080
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002081 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002082 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002083 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2084 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2085 ToPointeeType,
2086 ToType, Context);
2087 return true;
2088 }
2089
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002090 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2091 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002092 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002093 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002094 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002095 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002096 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002097 return true;
2098 }
2099
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002100 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002101 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002102 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2103 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2104 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2105 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2106 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2107 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2108 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2109 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2110 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002111 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2112 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002113 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002114 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002115 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002116 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002117 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002118 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002119 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002120 ToType, Context);
2121 return true;
2122 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002123
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002124 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2125 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2126 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2127 ToPointeeType,
2128 ToType, Context);
2129 return true;
2130 }
2131
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002132 return false;
2133}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002134
2135/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2136static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2137 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2138
2139 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2140 if (TQs == Qs)
2141 return T;
2142
2143 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2144 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2145
2146 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2147}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002148
2149/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2150/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2151/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002153 QualType& ConvertedType,
2154 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002155 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002156 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002157
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002158 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2159 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2160
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002161 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002162 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2163 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002164 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002165 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002166
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002167 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002168 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2169 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2170 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2171 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2172 return false;
2173
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002174 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002175 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002176 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002177 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002178 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002179 return true;
2180 }
2181 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002182 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002183 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002184 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002185 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002186 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002187 return true;
2188 }
2189 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2190 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2191 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002192 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2193 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002194 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002195 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2196 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2197 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002198 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002199 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2200 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002201 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002202 return true;
2203 }
2204
2205 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2206 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2207 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2208 // complain about it.
2209 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002210 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002211 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2212 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002213 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002214 return true;
2215 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002216 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002217 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002218 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002219 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002220 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002221 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002222 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002223 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002224 // to a block pointer type.
2225 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002226 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002227 return true;
2228 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002229 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002230 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002231 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002232 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002233 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002234 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002235 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002236 return true;
2237 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002238 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002239 return false;
2240
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002241 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002242 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002243 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002244 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2245 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002246 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2247 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002248 return false;
2249
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002250 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2251 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2252 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2253 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2254 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2255 // We always complain about this conversion.
2256 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002257 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002258 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002259 return true;
2260 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002261 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2262 // as in I* to id.
2263 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2264 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2265 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2266 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002267
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002268 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002269 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002270 return true;
2271 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002272
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002273 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002274 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2275 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2276 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002277 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002278 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002279 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002280 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002281 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2282 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2283 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2284 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2285 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2286 return false;
2287
2288 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2289 // function types are obviously different.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002290 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002291 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2292 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2293 return false;
2294
2295 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002296 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2297 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002298 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002299 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2300 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002301 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2302 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2303 HasObjCConversion = true;
2304 } else {
2305 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2306 return false;
2307 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002309 // Check argument types.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002310 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002311 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002312 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2313 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002314 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2315 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2316 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2317 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2318 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2319 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2320 HasObjCConversion = true;
2321 } else {
2322 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2323 return false;
2324 }
2325 }
2326
2327 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2328 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2329 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002330 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002331 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2332 return true;
2333 }
2334 }
2335
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002336 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002337}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002338
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002339/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2340/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2341///
2342/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2343///
2344/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2345///
2346/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2347/// this conversion.
2348bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2349 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002350 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002351 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2352 return false;
2353
2354 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2355 QualType ToPointee;
2356 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2357 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2358 else
2359 return false;
2360
2361 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2362 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2363 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002364 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002365 return false;
2366
2367 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2368 QualType FromPointee;
2369 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2370 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2371 else
2372 return false;
2373
2374 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2375 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2376 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2377 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2378 return false;
2379
2380 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2381 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2382 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2383 return false;
2384
2385 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2386 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2387 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2388 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2389
2390 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2391 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2392 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2393 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2394 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2395 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2396 IncompatibleObjC))
2397 return false;
2398
2399 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2400 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2401 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2402 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2403 return true;
2404}
2405
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002406bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2407 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2408 QualType ToPointeeType;
2409 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2410 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2411 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2412 else
2413 return false;
2414
2415 QualType FromPointeeType;
2416 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2417 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2418 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2419 else
2420 return false;
2421 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2422 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2423 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2424
2425 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2426 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2427 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2428 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2429
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002430 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2431 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002432
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002433 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002434 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002435
2436 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2437 // function types are obviously different.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002438 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002439 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2440 return false;
2441
2442 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2443 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2444 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2445 return false;
2446
2447 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002448 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2449 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002450 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2451 } else {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002452 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2453 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002454 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002455 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2456 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2457
2458 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2459 // OK exact match.
2460 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2461 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2462 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2463 return false;
2464 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2465 }
2466 else
2467 return false;
2468 }
2469
2470 // Check argument types.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002471 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002472 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2473 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002474 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2475 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002476 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2477 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2478 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2479 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2480 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2481 return false;
2482 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2483 } else
2484 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2485 return false;
2486 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002487 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2488 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2489 ToFunctionType))
2490 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian600ba202011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002491
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002492 ConvertedType = ToType;
2493 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002494}
2495
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002496enum {
2497 ft_default,
2498 ft_different_class,
2499 ft_parameter_arity,
2500 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2501 ft_return_type,
2502 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2503};
2504
2505/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2506/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2507/// parameter types, and different return types.
2508void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2509 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002510 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2511 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2512 PDiag << ft_default;
2513 return;
2514 }
2515
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002516 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2517 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2518 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2519 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Richard Trieu9098c9f2014-05-22 01:39:16 +00002520 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002521 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2522 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2523 return;
2524 }
2525 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2526 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002527 }
2528
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002529 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2530 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2531 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2532 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2533
2534 // Remove references.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002535 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2536 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2537
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002538 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2539 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2540 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2541 PDiag << ft_default;
2542 return;
2543 }
2544
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002545 // No extra info for same types.
2546 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2547 PDiag << ft_default;
2548 return;
2549 }
2550
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002551 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2552 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2553
2554 // Both types need to be function types.
2555 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2556 PDiag << ft_default;
2557 return;
2558 }
2559
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002560 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2561 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2562 << FromFunction->getNumParams();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002563 return;
2564 }
2565
2566 // Handle different parameter types.
2567 unsigned ArgPos;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002568 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002569 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002570 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2571 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002572 return;
2573 }
2574
2575 // Handle different return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002576 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2577 ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2578 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2579 << FromFunction->getReturnType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002580 return;
2581 }
2582
2583 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2584 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2585 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2586 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2587 return;
2588 }
2589
2590 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2591 PDiag << ft_default;
2592}
2593
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002594/// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002595/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Eli Friedman5f508952013-06-18 22:41:37 +00002596/// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different,
2597/// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002598bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2599 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2600 unsigned *ArgPos) {
2601 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2602 N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2603 E = OldType->param_type_end();
2604 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
Richard Trieu4b03d982013-08-09 21:42:32 +00002605 if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(),
2606 N->getUnqualifiedType())) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002607 if (ArgPos)
2608 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
Larisse Voufo4154f462013-08-06 03:57:41 +00002609 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002610 }
2611 }
2612 return true;
2613}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002614
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002615/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2616/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002617/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002618/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2619/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2620/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002621bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002622 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002623 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002624 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002625 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002626 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002627
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002628 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2629
David Blaikie1c7c8f72012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002630 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3e3305d2014-02-02 05:26:43 +00002631 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
David Blaikie1c7c8f72012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002632 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2633 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2634 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2635 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2636 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2637 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2638 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2639 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2640 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002641 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2642 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002643 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2644 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002645
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002646 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2647 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002648 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2649 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002650 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2651 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002652 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002653 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002654 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002655
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002656 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002657 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002658 }
2659 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002660 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2661 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2662 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2663 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002664 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2665 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2666 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002667 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002668 return false;
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002669 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2670 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2671 } else {
2672 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002673 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002674 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2675 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2676 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002677 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002678
2679 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2680 // reasons.
2681 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2682 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2683
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002684 return false;
2685}
2686
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002687/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2688/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2689/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2690/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2691/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2692bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002693 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002694 bool InOverloadResolution,
2695 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002696 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002697 if (!ToTypePtr)
2698 return false;
2699
2700 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002701 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2702 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2703 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002704 ConvertedType = ToType;
2705 return true;
2706 }
2707
2708 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002709 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002710 if (!FromTypePtr)
2711 return false;
2712
2713 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2714 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2715 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2716 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002717
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002718 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002719 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002720 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002721 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2722 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2723 return true;
2724 }
2725
2726 return false;
2727}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002728
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002729/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2730/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002731/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002732/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2733/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2734/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002735bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002736 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002737 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002738 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002739 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002740 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002741 if (!FromPtrType) {
2742 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002743 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002744 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002745 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002746 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002747 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002748 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002749
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002750 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002751 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2752 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002753
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002754 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2755 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002756
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002757 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2758 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2759 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002760
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002761 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002762 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002763 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2764 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2765 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2766 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002767
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002768 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2769 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002770 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2771 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2772 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2773 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002774 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002775
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002776 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002777 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2778 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2779 << From->getSourceRange();
2780 return true;
2781 }
2782
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002783 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002784 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2785 Paths.front(),
2786 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002787
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002788 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002789 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002790 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002791 return false;
2792}
2793
Douglas Gregorc9f019a2013-11-08 02:04:24 +00002794/// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
2795/// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
2796static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
2797 Qualifiers ToQuals) {
2798 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
2799 if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
2800 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
2801 return false;
2802
2803 return true;
2804}
2805
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002806/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2807/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2808/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002809///
2810/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2811/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2812/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002813bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002814Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002815 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002816 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2817 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002818 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2819
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002820 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2821 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002822 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002823 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002824
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002825 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2826 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2827 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2828 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002829 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002830 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002831 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2832 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2833 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002834 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002835 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2836 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002837 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002838
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002839 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2840 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2841
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002842 // Objective-C ARC:
2843 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2844 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2845 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2846 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc9f019a2013-11-08 02:04:24 +00002847 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
2848 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002849 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2850 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2851 } else {
2852 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2853 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2854 return false;
2855 }
2856 }
2857
Douglas Gregorf30053d2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002858 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2859 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2860 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2861 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2862 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2863 }
2864
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002865 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2866 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002867 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002868 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002869
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002870 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2871 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002872 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002873 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002874 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002875
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002876 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2877 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002878 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002879 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002880 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002881
2882 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2883 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2884 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2885 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2886 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002887 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002888}
2889
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002890/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2891/// atomic type.
2892///
2893/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2894/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregorf9e36cc2012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002895static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2896 bool InOverloadResolution,
2897 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2898 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002899 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2900 if (!ToAtomic)
2901 return false;
2902
2903 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2904 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2905 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2906 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2907 return false;
2908
2909 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2910 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2911 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2912 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2913 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2914 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2915 return true;
2916}
2917
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002918static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2919 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2920 QualType Type) {
2921 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2922 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002923 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
2924 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002925 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2926 return true;
2927 }
2928 return false;
2929}
2930
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002931static OverloadingResult
2932IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2933 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2934 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2935 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2936 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikieff7d47a2012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002937 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2938 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002939 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2940 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2941 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2942
2943 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00002944 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002945 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2946 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2947 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2948 Constructor
2949 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2950 else
2951 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2952
2953 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2954 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2955 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2956 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002957 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2958 // suppress conversions.
2959 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2960 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002961 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2962 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00002963 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002964 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002965 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002966 else
2967 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002968 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002969 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002970 }
2971 }
2972
2973 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2974
2975 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2976 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2977 case OR_Success: {
2978 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2979 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002980 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2981 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2982 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2983 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2984 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2985 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2986 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2987 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2988 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2989 return OR_Success;
2990 }
2991
2992 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2993 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2994 case OR_Deleted:
2995 return OR_Deleted;
2996 case OR_Ambiguous:
2997 return OR_Ambiguous;
2998 }
2999
3000 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3001}
3002
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003003/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3004/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3005/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3006/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3007/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3008/// false and User is unspecified.
3009///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003010/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3011/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3012/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003013///
3014/// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3015/// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3016/// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003017static OverloadingResult
3018IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003019 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3020 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003021 bool AllowExplicit,
3022 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor2ee1d992013-11-08 01:20:25 +00003023 assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003024
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003025 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3026 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3027
3028 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3029 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003030 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003031 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3032 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3033 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3034 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3035 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3036 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3037 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3038 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003039 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003040 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003041 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003042 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3043
Benjamin Kramer90633e32012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003044 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003045 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3046 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3047 // to try to recover.
3048 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003049 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3050 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3051 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003052
3053 Expr **Args = &From;
3054 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3055 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003056 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Benjamin Kramer60509af2013-09-09 14:48:42 +00003057 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003058 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3059 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3060 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3061 return Result;
3062 // Never mind.
3063 CandidateSet.clear();
3064
3065 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3066 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003067 Args = InitList->getInits();
3068 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3069 ListInitializing = true;
3070 }
3071
David Blaikieff7d47a2012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003072 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3073 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003074 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003075 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3076 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3077
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003078 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00003079 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003080 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003081 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003082 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003083 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003084 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3085 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003086 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003087
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003088 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3089 if (ListInitializing)
3090 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3091 else
3092 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3093 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003094 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3095 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3096 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3097 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3098 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3099 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003100 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3101 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003102 }
3103 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003104 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003105 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00003106 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003107 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003108 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003109 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003110 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3111 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003112 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003113 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003114 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003115 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003116 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003117 }
3118 }
3119
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003120 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003121 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003122 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003123 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003125 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003126 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003127 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3128 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003129 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3130 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3131 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3132 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3133 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003134 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3135 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003136 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3137 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3138 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3139
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003140 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3141 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003142 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3143 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003144 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003145 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003146
3147 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3148 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003149 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3150 ActingContext, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003151 CandidateSet,
3152 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003153 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003154 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003155 From, ToType, CandidateSet,
3156 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003157 }
3158 }
3159 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003160 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003161
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003162 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3163
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003164 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003165 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003166 case OR_Success:
3167 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3168 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3169 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3170 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3171 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3172 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3173 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3174 // the argument of the constructor.
3175 //
3176 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003177 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3178 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3179 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3180 } else {
3181 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3182 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3183 else {
3184 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3185 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3186 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003187 }
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003188 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003189 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003190 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003191 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3192 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3193 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3194 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003195 }
3196 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003197 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3198 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3199 //
3200 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3201 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3202 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3203 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3204 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003205 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003206 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003207 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003208 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003209
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003210 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3211 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3212 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3213 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3214 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3215 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3216 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3217 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3218 // 13.3.3.1).
3219 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3220 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003221 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003222 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003223
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003224 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3225 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3226 case OR_Deleted:
3227 // No conversion here! We're done.
3228 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003229
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003230 case OR_Ambiguous:
3231 return OR_Ambiguous;
3232 }
3233
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003234 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003235}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003236
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003237bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003238Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003239 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00003240 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3241 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003242 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003243 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003244 CandidateSet, false, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003245 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003246 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3247 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
Larisse Voufo64cf3ef2013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003248 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
Larisse Voufo70bb43a2013-06-27 03:36:30 +00003249 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003250 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
Larisse Voufo64cf3ef2013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003251 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003252 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3253 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3254 } else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003255 return false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003256 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003257 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003258}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003259
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003260/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3261/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3262/// is possible.
3263static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003264compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003265 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003266 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003267 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003268
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003269 // Objective-C++:
3270 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003271 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003272 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3273 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3274 // to keep code working.
Ted Kremenek8d265c22014-04-01 07:23:18 +00003275 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003276 if (!Conv1)
3277 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003278
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003279 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3280 if (!Conv2)
3281 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003282
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003283 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3284 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3285 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3286 if (Block1 != Block2)
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003287 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3288 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003289 }
3290
3291 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3292}
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003293
3294static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3295 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3296 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3297 (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3298 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3299}
3300
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003301/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3302/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3303/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003304static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3305CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3306 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3307 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003308{
3309 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3310 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3311 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3312 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3313 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3314 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3315 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3316 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003317 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003318 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3319 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3320 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3321 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3322 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003323
3324 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3325 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3326 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3327 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3328 // standard. For example:
3329 //
3330 // int &f(...); // #1
3331 // void f(char*); // #2
3332 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3333 //
3334 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3335 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3336 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3337 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3338 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3339 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3340 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3341
3342 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3343 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3344 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3345 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3346 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3347 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3348
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003349 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3350 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003351 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003352 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003353
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003354 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3355 // the same kind.
3356 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3357 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3358
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003359 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3360 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3361
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003362 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3363 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3364 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003365 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003366 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3367 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003368 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003369 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3370 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3371 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3372 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3373 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3374 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003375 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003376 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003377 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3378 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3379 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003380 else
3381 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3382 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3383 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003384 }
3385
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003386 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3387 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3388 // for some X and L2 does not.
3389 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +00003390 !ICS1.isBad()) {
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003391 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3392 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3393 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3394 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3395 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3396 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003397 }
3398
3399 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003400}
3401
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003402static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3403 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3404 Qualifiers Quals;
3405 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003406 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003407 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003408
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003409 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3410}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003411
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003412// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3413// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3414static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3415compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3416 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3417 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3418 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3419 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3420
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003421 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003422 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor377c1092011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003423 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3424 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3425 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3426 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003427
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003428 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3429 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3430 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3431 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3432 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3433 else
3434 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003435 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003436 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3437
3438 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3439 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3440 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3441 }
3442
3443 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3444 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3445 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3446 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3447
3448 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3449 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3450 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3451 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003452
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003453 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3454}
3455
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003456/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3457/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00003458static bool
3459isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3460 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003461 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3462 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3463 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003464 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003465 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003466 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003467 // reference*.
3468 //
3469 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3470 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3471 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3472 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3473 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003474 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3475 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3476 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003477
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003478 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3479 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3480 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00003481 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003482}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003483
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003484/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3485/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3486/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003487static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3488CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3489 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3490 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003491{
3492 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3493 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3494
3495 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3496 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3497 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3498 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3499 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003500 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003501 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003502 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003503
3504 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3505 // defined below), or, if not that,
3506 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3507 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3508 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3509 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3510 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3511 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003512
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003513 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3514 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3515 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003516
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003517 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3518 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3519 // that is such a conversion.
3520 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3521 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3522 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3523 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3524
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003525 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3526 //
3527 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003528 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3529 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3530 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003531 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003532 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003533 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003534 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003535 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3536 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3537 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003538 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3539 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003540 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3541 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3542 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003543 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003544 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003545 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003546 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3547 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003548 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3549 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3550 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003551 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3552 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003553
3554 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3555 // conversion, if we need to.
3556 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003557 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003558 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003559 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003560
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003561 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3562 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003563
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003564 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003565 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003566 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003567 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3568
3569 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3570 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003571 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3572 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3573 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3574 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3575 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3576 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3577 FromObjCPtr2);
3578 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3579 FromObjCPtr1);
3580 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3581 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3582 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3583 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003584 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003585 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003586
3587 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3588 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003589 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003590 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003591 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003592
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003593 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003594 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3595 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3596 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3597 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003599
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003600 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3601 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3602 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3603 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3604 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3605 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003606 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3607 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003608 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3609 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003610 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003611 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3612 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003613 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003614 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3615 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3616 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3617 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3618 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3619 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3620 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3621 }
3622
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003623 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3624 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003625 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003626 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003627 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003628 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003629 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3630 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3631 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003632 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003633 }
3634 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003635
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003636 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3637 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3638 // is between types of the same size.
3639 // For example:
3640 // void f(float);
3641 // void f(int);
3642 // int main {
3643 // long a;
3644 // f(a);
3645 // }
3646 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3647 // as clang will do in standard mode.
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +00003648 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3649 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003650 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +00003651 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003652 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3653
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003654 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3655}
3656
3657/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3658/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003659/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3660ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003661CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3662 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3663 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003664 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003665 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3666 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3667 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3668 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3669 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3670 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3671 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3672 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3673
3674 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3675 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003676 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3677 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003678 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3679 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003680 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003681 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3682 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003683
3684 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3685 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003686 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003687 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3688
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003689 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3690 // for comparison.
3691 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003692 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003693 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003694 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003695
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003696 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003697 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003698
3699 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3700 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3701 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3702 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3703 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3704 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3705 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3706 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3707 }
3708
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003709 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003710 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3711 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3712 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003713 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003714 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3715 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3716 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3717 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3718 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3719 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3720 // about how the sequences rank.
3721 ;
3722 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3723 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3724 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3725 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3726 // qualifiers.
3727 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003728
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003729 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3730 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3731 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3732 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3733 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3734 // qualifiers.
3735 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003736
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003737 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3738 } else {
3739 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3740 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3741 }
3742
3743 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003744 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003745 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003746 }
3747
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003748 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3749 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3750 switch (Result) {
3751 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003752 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003753 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3754 break;
3755
3756 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3757 break;
3758
3759 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003760 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003761 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3762 break;
3763 }
3764
3765 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003766}
3767
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003768/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3769/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003770/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3771/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3772/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003773ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003774CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3775 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3776 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003777 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003778 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003779 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003780 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003781
3782 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3783 // conversion, if we need to.
3784 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003785 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003786 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003787 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003788
3789 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003790 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3791 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3792 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3793 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003794
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003795 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003796 //
3797 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3798 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003799 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003800 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003801 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003802 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3803 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3804 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3805 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003806 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003807 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003808 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003809 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003810 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003811 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003812 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003813 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003814
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003815 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003816 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003817 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003819 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003820 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3821 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003822
3823 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3824 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003825 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003827 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003829 }
3830 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3831 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3832 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3833 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3834 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3835 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3836 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3837 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3838 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3839 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3840
3841 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3842 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3843 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3844 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3845 // Objective-C pointer types.
3846 bool FromAssignLeft
3847 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3848 bool FromAssignRight
3849 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3850 bool ToAssignLeft
3851 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3852 bool ToAssignRight
3853 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3854
3855 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3856 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3857 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3858 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3859 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3860 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3861 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3863
3864 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3865 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3866 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3867 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3868 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3869 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3870
3871 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3872 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3873 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3874 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3875 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3876 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3877 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3878 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3879
3880 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3881 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3882 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3883 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3884 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3885 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003886
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003887 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3888 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3889 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3890 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3891 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3892 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3893
3894 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3895 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3896 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3897 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3898 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003899 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003900 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003901
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003902 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003903 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3904 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3905 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003906 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003907 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003908 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003909 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003910 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003911 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003912 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003913 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3914 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3915 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3916 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3917 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3918 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3919 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3920 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3921 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003922 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003923 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003924 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003925 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003926 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003927 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3928 }
3929 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3930 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003931 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003932 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003933 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003934 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3935 }
3936 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003937
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003938 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003939 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003940 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3941 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3942 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003943 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3944 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3945 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003946 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003947 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003948 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3949 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003950
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003951 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003952 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3953 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3954 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003955 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3956 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3957 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003958 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003959 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003960 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3961 }
3962 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003963
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003964 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3965}
3966
Douglas Gregor45bb4832013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003967/// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3968/// C++ class.
3969static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3970 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3971 return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3972
3973 return true;
3974}
3975
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003976/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3977/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3978/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3979/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3980/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3981/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3982/// type being initialized.
3983Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3984Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3985 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003986 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003987 bool &ObjCConversion,
3988 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003989 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3990 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3991 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3992
3993 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3994 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3995 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3996 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3997 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3998
3999 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4000 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4001 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
4002 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004003 DerivedToBase = false;
4004 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004005 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004006 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4007 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004008 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor45bb4832013-03-26 23:36:30 +00004009 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4010 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004011 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004012 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4013 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4014 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4015 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004016 else
4017 return Ref_Incompatible;
4018
4019 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
4020 // least).
4021
4022 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
4023 // for comparison.
4024 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4025 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4026 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4027 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4028
4029 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4030 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
4031 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
4032 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
4033 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
4034 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
4035 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004036 //
4037 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
4038 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
4039 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
4040 // space 2.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004041 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4042 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
Douglas Gregorc9f019a2013-11-08 02:04:24 +00004043 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals))
4044 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4045
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004046 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4047 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004048 }
4049
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004050 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004051 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004052 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004053 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4054 else
4055 return Ref_Related;
4056}
4057
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004058/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004059/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4060static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004061FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4062 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4063 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4064 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004065 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4066 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4067 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4068
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00004069 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004070 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4071 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4072 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4073 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4074 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004075 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4076 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4077 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4078 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4079
4080 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4081 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4082 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4083 if (ConvTemplate)
4084 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4085 else
4086 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4087
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004088 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004089 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4090 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4091 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004092
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004093 if (AllowRvalues) {
4094 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4095 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004096 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004097
4098 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4099 // functions that return lvalues.
4100 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4101 const ReferenceType *RefType
4102 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4103 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4104 continue;
4105 }
4106
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004107 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004108 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4109 DeclLoc,
4110 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4111 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4112 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004113 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004114 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004115 continue;
4116 } else {
4117 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4118 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4119 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4120
4121 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4122 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4123 if (!RefType ||
4124 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4125 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4126 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004127 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004128
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004129 if (ConvTemplate)
4130 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004131 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4132 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004133 else
4134 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004135 DeclType, CandidateSet,
4136 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004137 }
4138
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004139 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4140
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004141 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004142 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004143 case OR_Success:
4144 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4145 //
4146 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4147 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4148 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4149 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4150 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4151 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4152 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4153 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4154 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4155 return false;
4156
4157 ICS.setUserDefined();
4158 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4159 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004160 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004161 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004162 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004163 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4164 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4165 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4166 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4167 return true;
4168
4169 case OR_Ambiguous:
4170 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4171 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4172 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4173 if (Cand->Viable)
4174 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4175 return true;
4176
4177 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4178 case OR_Deleted:
4179 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4180 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4181 return false;
4182 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004183
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004184 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004185}
4186
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004187/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4188/// initialization.
4189static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004190TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004191 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4192 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004193 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004194 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4195
4196 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4197 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4198 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4199
4200 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4201 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4202
4203 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4204 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4205 // type of the resulting function.
4206 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4207 DeclAccessPair Found;
4208 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4209 false, Found))
4210 T2 = Fn->getType();
4211 }
4212
4213 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4214 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4215 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004216 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004217 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004218 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004219 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004220 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004221 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004222
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004223
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004224 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004225 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4226 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4227
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004228 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004229 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004230 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4231 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4232 //
4233 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4234 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4235 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004236 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004237 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4238 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4239 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4240 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4241 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4242 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4243 ICS.setStandard();
4244 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004245 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4246 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4247 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004248 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4249 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4250 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4251 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4252 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4253 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4254 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004255 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4256 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4257 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004258 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004259 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00004260 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00004261 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004262
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004263 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4264 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4265 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4266 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004267 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004268 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004269
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004270 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4271 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4272 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4273 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4274 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4275 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4276 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4277 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004278 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004279 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004280 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4281 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4282 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004283 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004284 }
4285 }
4286
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004287 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4288 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004289 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004290 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004291 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4292 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4293 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4294 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4295 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4296 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4297 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004298 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4299 // go together.
Richard Smithce4f6082012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004300 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004301 return ICS;
4302
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004303 // -- If the initializer expression
4304 //
4305 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004306 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004307 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4308 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4309 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4310 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4311 ICS.setStandard();
4312 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004313 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004314 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4315 : ICK_Identity;
4316 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4317 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4318 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4319 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4320 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4321 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4322 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4323 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4324 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4325 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4326 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004327 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004328 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Richard Smithb94afe12014-07-14 19:54:05 +00004329 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004330 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4331 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004332 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004333 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004334 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00004335 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00004336 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004337 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004338 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004339
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004340 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4341 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004342 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4343 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004344 // "cv3 T3",
4345 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004346 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004347 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004348 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004349 // class subobject).
4350 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004351 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004352 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4353 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4354 AllowExplicit)) {
4355 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4356 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4357 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4358 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004359 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004360 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4361 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4362
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004363 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004364 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004365
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004366 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4367 if (T1->isFunctionType())
4368 return ICS;
4369
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004370 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4371 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4372 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4373 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4374 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4375 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4376 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4377 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4378 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4379 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4380 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4381 // initialization fails.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004382 //
4383 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4384 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4385 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4386 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4387 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4388 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4389 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4390 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4391 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4392 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004393 }
4394
4395 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4396 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4397 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4398 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4399 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4400 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4401 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4402 return ICS;
4403
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004404 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4405 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4406 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4407 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4408 return ICS;
4409
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004410 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004411 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4412 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4413 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4414 // underlying type of the reference according to
4415 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4416 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4417 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4418 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4419 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004420 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4421 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004422 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004423 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004424 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4425 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004426
4427 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4428 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4429 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004430 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004431 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004432 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004433 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004434 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004435 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004436 const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4437 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4438 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4439
4440 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4441 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4442 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4443 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4444 // lvalue.
4445 // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4446 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) {
4447 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding
4448 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue
4449 // reference to an rvalue!
4450 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4451 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004452 }
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004453
Ismail Pazarbasi99afd962014-01-24 10:54:12 +00004454 ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004455 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004456 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004457 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4458 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004459 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4460 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004461 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004462
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004463 return ICS;
4464}
4465
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004466static ImplicitConversionSequence
4467TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4468 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4469 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004470 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4471 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004472
4473/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4474/// initializer list From.
4475static ImplicitConversionSequence
4476TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4477 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4478 bool InOverloadResolution,
4479 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4480 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4481 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4482 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4483
4484 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4485 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
4486
Sebastian Redl09edce02012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004487 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004488 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004489 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004490 return Result;
4491
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004492 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4493 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4494 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4495 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4496 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004497 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004498 QualType X;
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004499 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith0db1ea52012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004500 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004501 else
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004502 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004503 if (!X.isNull()) {
4504 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4505 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4506 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4507 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4508 InOverloadResolution,
4509 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4510 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4511 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4512 Result = ICS;
4513 break;
4514 }
4515 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4516 if (Result.isBad() ||
4517 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4518 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4519 Result = ICS;
4520 }
Douglas Gregor0f5c1c02012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004521
4522 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4523 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4524 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4525 Result.setStandard();
4526 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4527 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4528 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4529 }
4530
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004531 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004532 return Result;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004533 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004534
4535 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4536 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4537 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4538 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4539 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4540 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004541 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4542 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +00004543 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4544 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4545 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004546 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4547 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004548 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004549
4550 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4551 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4552 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4553 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004554 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004555 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4556 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4557 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4558 InitializedEntity Entity =
4559 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4560 /*Consumed=*/false);
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00004561 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004562 Result.setUserDefined();
4563 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4564 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4565 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4566 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4567
4568 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4569 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4570 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00004571 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004572 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004573 return Result;
4574 }
4575
4576 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4577 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004578 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4579 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4580 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4581 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4582
4583 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4584
4585 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4586 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4587 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4588 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4589
4590 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4591
4592 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4593 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4594 // type of the resulting function.
4595 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4596 DeclAccessPair Found;
4597 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4598 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4599 T2 = Fn->getType();
4600 }
4601
4602 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4603 bool dummy1 = false;
4604 bool dummy2 = false;
4605 bool dummy3 = false;
4606 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4607 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4608 dummy2, dummy3);
4609
Richard Smith4d2bbd72013-09-06 01:22:42 +00004610 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +00004611 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(),
4612 SuppressUserConversions,
4613 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Richard Smith4d2bbd72013-09-06 01:22:42 +00004614 }
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004615 }
4616
4617 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4618 // initializer list.
4619 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4620 InOverloadResolution,
4621 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4622 if (Result.isFailure())
4623 return Result;
4624 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4625 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4626
4627 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4628 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4629 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4630 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4631 Result.UserDefined.After;
4632 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4633 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4634 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4635 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4636 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4637 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4638 } else
4639 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4640 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004641 return Result;
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004642 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004643
4644 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4645 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4646 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4647 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4648 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4649 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004650 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4651 if (NumInits == 1)
4652 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4653 SuppressUserConversions,
4654 InOverloadResolution,
4655 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4656 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4657 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4658 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4659 Result.setStandard();
4660 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCallb73bc9a2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004661 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4662 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004663 }
4664 return Result;
4665 }
4666
4667 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4668 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4669 return Result;
4670}
4671
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004672/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4673/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4674/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4675/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004676/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004677/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004678static ImplicitConversionSequence
4679TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004680 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004681 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004682 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4683 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004684 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4685 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4686 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4687
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004688 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004689 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004690 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4691 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004692 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004693
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004694 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4695 SuppressUserConversions,
4696 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004697 InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004698 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004699 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4700 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004701}
4702
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004703static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4704 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4705 Sema &S,
4706 SourceLocation Loc,
4707 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4708 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4709 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4710 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4711
4712 return !ICS.isBad();
4713}
4714
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004715/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4716/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4717/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004718static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith03c66d32013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004719TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004720 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004721 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4722 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4723 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004724 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4725 // const volatile object.
4726 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4727 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004728 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004729
4730 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4731 // to exit early.
4732 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004733
4734 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004735 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004736 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4737
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004738 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4739 // better have an lvalue.
4740 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4741 }
4742
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004743 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004744
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004745 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004746 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004747 // parameter is
4748 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004749 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4750 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4751 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004752 // ref-qualifier
4753 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004754 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004755 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4756 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004757 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004758 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004759 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4760 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4761 // non-constant references.
4762
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004763 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004764 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004765 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004766 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004767 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004768 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith03c66d32013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004769 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004770 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004771 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004772
4773 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4774 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004775 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004776 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4777 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4778 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004779 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004780 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004781 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004782 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4783 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004784 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004785 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004786
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004787 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4788 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4789 case RQ_None:
4790 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4791 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004792
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004793 case RQ_LValue:
4794 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4795 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004796 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004797 ImplicitParamType);
4798 return ICS;
4799 }
4800 break;
4801
4802 case RQ_RValue:
4803 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4804 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004805 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004806 ImplicitParamType);
4807 return ICS;
4808 }
4809 break;
4810 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004811
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004812 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004813 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004814 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4815 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004816 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004817 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004818 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4819 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004820 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004821 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004822 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4823 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4824 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004825 return ICS;
4826}
4827
4828/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4829/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4830/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004831ExprResult
4832Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004833 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004834 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004835 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004836 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004837 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004838 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004840 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004841 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004842 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4843 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004844 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004845 } else {
4846 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4847 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004848 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004849 }
4850
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004851 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4852 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004853 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004854 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4855 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004856 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4857 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4858 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4859 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4860 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4861 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004862 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004863 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4864 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4865 << From->getSourceRange();
4866 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4867 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004868 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004869 }
4870 }
4871
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004872 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004873 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004874 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004875 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004876
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004877 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4878 ExprResult FromRes =
4879 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4880 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4881 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00004882 From = FromRes.get();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004883 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004884
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004885 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004886 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00004887 From->getValueKind()).get();
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00004888 return From;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004889}
4890
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004891/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4892/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004893static ImplicitConversionSequence
4894TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004895 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004896 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004897 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004898 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004899 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004900 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4901 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004902}
4903
4904/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4905/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004906ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004907 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4908 return ExprError();
4909
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004910 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004911 if (!ICS.isBad())
4912 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004913
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004914 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004915 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004916 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004917 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004918 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004919}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004920
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004921/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4922/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4923/// is acceptable.
4924static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4925 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4926 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4927 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4928 // conversions are fine.
4929 switch (SCS.Second) {
4930 case ICK_Identity:
4931 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4932 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei259f9f42013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004933 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004934 return true;
4935
4936 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smithca24ed42012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004937 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4938 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4939 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4940 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4941 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4942
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004943 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4944 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4945 return false;
4946
4947 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4948 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4949 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4950 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4951 case ICK_Qualification:
4952 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4953 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4954 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4955 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4956 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4957 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4958 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4959 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4960 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4961 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4962 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4963 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4964 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4965 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4966
4967 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4968 break;
4969 }
4970
4971 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4972}
4973
4974/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4975/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4976/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4977ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4978 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4979 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004980 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004981 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4982
4983 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4984 return ExprError();
4985
4986 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4987 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4988 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4989 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4990 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4991 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4992 // narrowing conversions.
4993 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4994 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4995 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4996 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4997 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4998 /*CStyle=*/false,
4999 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005000 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005001 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5002 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5003 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005004 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005005 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5006 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5007 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5008 break;
5009 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5010 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
5011 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
5012 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005013 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005014 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5015 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5016 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5017 break;
5018 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5019 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5020 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005021 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005022 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5023 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5024 return ExprError();
5025
5026 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5027 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5028 }
5029
5030 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
5031 if (Result.isInvalid())
5032 return Result;
5033
5034 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5035 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005036 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005037 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5038 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005039 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5040 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5041 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5042 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5043 break;
5044
5045 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Richard Smith16e1b072013-11-12 02:41:45 +00005046 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005047 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005048 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005049 break;
5050
5051 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Richard Smith16e1b072013-11-12 02:41:45 +00005052 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005053 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5054 break;
5055 }
5056
5057 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005058 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005059 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5060 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5061
Douglas Gregorebe2db72013-04-08 23:24:07 +00005062 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context) || !Eval.Val.isInt()) {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005063 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5064 // the AST.
5065 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005066 } else {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005067 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005068
5069 if (Notes.empty()) {
5070 // It's a constant expression.
5071 return Result;
5072 }
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005073 }
5074
5075 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5076 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5077 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5078 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5079 else {
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005080 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005081 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5082 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5083 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5084 }
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005085 return Result;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005086}
5087
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005088/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5089/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5090/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5091static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5092 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5093 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5094 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5095 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5096 }
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005097}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005098
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005099/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5100/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5101static ImplicitConversionSequence
5102TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5103 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5104 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5105 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5106 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5107 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5108 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5109 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5110 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5111 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005112 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5113 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005114
5115 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5116 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5117 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5118 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5119 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5120 break;
5121
5122 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5123 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5124 break;
5125
5126 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5127 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5128 break;
5129 }
5130
5131 return ICS;
5132}
5133
5134/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5135/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5136ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005137 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5138 return ExprError();
5139
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005140 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005141 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5142 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005143 if (!ICS.isBad())
5144 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005145 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005146}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005147
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005148/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5149/// type of a permitted flavor.
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005150bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5151 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5152 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005153}
5154
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005155static ExprResult
5156diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5157 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5158 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5159
5160 if (Converter.Suppress)
5161 return ExprError();
5162
5163 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5164 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5165 CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5166 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5167 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5168 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5169 }
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005170 return From;
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005171}
5172
5173static bool
5174diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5175 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5176 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5177 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5178 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5179 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5180 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5181 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5182
5183 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5184 // conversion; use it.
5185 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5186 std::string TypeStr;
5187 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5188
5189 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5190 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5191 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5192 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
Alp Tokerb6cc5922014-05-03 03:45:55 +00005193 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005194 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5195
5196 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5197 // explicit conversion function.
5198 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5199 return true;
5200
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005201 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005202 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5203 HadMultipleCandidates);
5204 if (Result.isInvalid())
5205 return true;
5206 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5207 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005208 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5209 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005210 }
5211 return false;
5212}
5213
5214static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5215 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5216 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5217 DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5218 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5219 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005220 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005221
5222 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5223 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5224 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5225 return true;
5226
5227 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5228 << From->getSourceRange();
5229 }
5230
5231 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5232 HadMultipleCandidates);
5233 if (Result.isInvalid())
5234 return true;
5235 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5236 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005237 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5238 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005239 return false;
5240}
5241
5242static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5243 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5244 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5245 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5246 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5247 << From->getSourceRange();
5248
5249 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5250}
5251
5252static void
5253collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5254 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5255 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5256 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5257 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5258 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5259 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5260 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5261 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5262
5263 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5264 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5265 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5266 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5267 else
5268 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5269
5270 if (ConvTemplate)
5271 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005272 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
5273 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005274 else
5275 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005276 ToType, CandidateSet,
5277 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005278 }
5279}
5280
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005281/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5282/// by the given converter.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005283///
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005284/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5285/// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5286/// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5287/// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5288/// one target type.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005289///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005290/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5291/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005292///
James Dennett18348b62012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005293/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005294///
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005295/// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005296///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005297/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5298/// successful.
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005299ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5300 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005301 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5302 if (From->isTypeDependent())
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005303 return From;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005304
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005305 // Process placeholders immediately.
5306 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5307 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005308 if (result.isInvalid())
5309 return result;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00005310 From = result.get();
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005311 }
5312
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005313 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005314 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005315 if (Converter.match(T))
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005316 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005317
5318 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5319
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005320 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5321 // type.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005322 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005323 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005324 if (!Converter.Suppress)
5325 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005326 return From;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005327 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005328
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005329 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregora6c5abb2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005330 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005331 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
Douglas Gregore2b37442012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005332 Expr *From;
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005333
5334 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5335 : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5336
Craig Toppere14c0f82014-03-12 04:55:44 +00005337 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005338 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005339 }
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005340 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005341
5342 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005343 return From;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005344
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005345 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005346 UnresolvedSet<4>
5347 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005348 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005349 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005350 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions =
5351 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005352
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005353 bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5354 (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005355
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005356 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5357 QualType ToType;
5358 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5359
5360 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5361 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator I = Conversions.first,
5362 E = Conversions.second;
5363 I != E; ++I) {
5364 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5365 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5366 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5367 if (ConvTemplate) {
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005368 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005369 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5370 else
5371 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5372 } else
5373 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5374
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005375 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005376 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5377 "viable in C++1y");
5378
5379 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5380 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5381
5382 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5383 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5384 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5385 if (!ConvTemplate)
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005386 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005387 } else {
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005388 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005389 if (ToType.isNull())
5390 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5391 else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5392 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5393 HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5394 }
5395 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005396 }
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005397 }
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005398 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005399
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005400 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005401 // C++1y [conv]p6:
5402 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5403 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5404 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5405 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
Larisse Voufo67170bd2013-06-10 08:25:58 +00005406 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5407 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005408 // exactly one such T.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005409
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005410 // If no unique T is found:
5411 if (ToType.isNull()) {
5412 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5413 HadMultipleCandidates,
5414 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005415 return ExprError();
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005416 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005417 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005418
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005419 // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5420 if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5421 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5422 ViableConversions);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005423
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005424 // If one unique T is found:
5425 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5426 // potentially viable conversions.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00005427 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005428 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5429 CandidateSet);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005430
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005431 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5432 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5433 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5434 case OR_Success: {
5435 // Apply this conversion.
5436 DeclAccessPair Found =
5437 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5438 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5439 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5440 return ExprError();
5441 break;
5442 }
5443 case OR_Ambiguous:
5444 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5445 ViableConversions);
5446 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5447 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5448 HadMultipleCandidates,
5449 ExplicitConversions))
5450 return ExprError();
5451 // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case.
5452 case OR_Deleted:
5453 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5454 break;
5455 }
5456 } else {
5457 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5458 case 0: {
5459 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5460 HadMultipleCandidates,
5461 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005462 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005463
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005464 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5465 break;
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005466 }
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005467 case 1: {
5468 // Apply this conversion.
5469 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5470 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5471 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5472 return ExprError();
5473 break;
5474 }
5475 default:
5476 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5477 ViableConversions);
5478 }
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005479 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005480
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005481 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005482}
5483
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00005484/// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
5485/// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
5486/// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
5487/// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
5488/// enumeration types.
5489static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
5490 FunctionDecl *Fn,
5491 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
5492 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
5493 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
5494
5495 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
5496 return true;
5497
5498 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
5499 return true;
5500
5501 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5502 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
5503 return false;
5504
5505 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
5506 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
5507 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
5508 return true;
5509 }
5510
5511 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
5512 return false;
5513
5514 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
5515 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
5516 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
5517 return true;
5518 }
5519
5520 return false;
5521}
5522
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005523/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005524/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5525/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5526/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005527///
James Dennett2a4d13c2012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005528/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005529/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5530/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005531void
5532Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005533 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005534 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005535 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005536 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005537 bool PartialOverloading,
5538 bool AllowExplicit) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005539 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005540 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005541 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005542 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005543 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005544
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005545 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005546 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5547 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5548 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5549 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5550 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005551 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5552 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5553 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005554 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005555 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005556 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005557 return;
5558 }
5559 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5560 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005561 }
5562
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005563 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005564 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005565
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00005566 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5567 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
5568 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
5569 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
5570 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
5571 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
5572 // candidate functions.
5573 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
5574 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
5575 return;
5576
Richard Smith8b86f2d2013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005577 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
5578 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
5579 // overload resolution.
5580 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
5581 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
5582 Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
5583 return;
5584
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005585 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005586 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005587
Richard Smith8b86f2d2013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005588 if (Constructor) {
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005589 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5590 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5591 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5592 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005593 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005594 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005595 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5596 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005597 return;
5598 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005599
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005600 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005601 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005602 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005603 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005604 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005605 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005606 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005607 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005608
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005609 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005610
5611 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5612 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5613 // list (8.3.5).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005614 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumParams &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005615 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005616 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005617 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005618 return;
5619 }
5620
5621 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5622 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5623 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5624 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5625 // exactly m parameters.
5626 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005627 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005628 // Not enough arguments.
5629 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005630 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005631 return;
5632 }
5633
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005634 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005635 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005636 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5637 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5638 Candidate.Viable = false;
5639 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5640 return;
5641 }
5642
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005643 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5644 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005645 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005646 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005647 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5648 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5649 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5650 // parameter of F.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00005651 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005652 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005653 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005654 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005655 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5656 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005657 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005658 AllowExplicit);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005659 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5660 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005661 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005662 return;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005663 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005664 } else {
5665 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5666 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5667 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005668 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005669 }
5670 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005671
5672 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) {
5673 Candidate.Viable = false;
5674 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
5675 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
5676 return;
5677 }
5678}
5679
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005680ObjCMethodDecl *Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args,
Fariborz Jahanian0ded4242014-08-13 21:24:14 +00005681 bool IsInstance) {
5682 SmallVector<ObjCMethodDecl*, 4> Methods;
5683 if (!CollectMultipleMethodsInGlobalPool(Sel, Methods, IsInstance))
5684 return nullptr;
5685
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005686 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
5687 bool Match = true;
5688 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
5689 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
5690 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
5691 // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
5692 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
5693 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
5694 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
5695 continue;
5696
5697 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
5698 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
5699 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
5700 Match = false;
5701 break;
5702 }
5703
5704 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
5705 Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
5706 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
5707
5708 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
5709 // a consumed argument.
5710 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
5711 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
5712 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
5713
5714 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
5715 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
5716 Match = false;
5717 break;
5718 }
5719
5720 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
5721 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
5722 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
5723 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5724 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5725 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5726 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
5727 if (ConversionState.isBad()) {
5728 Match = false;
5729 break;
5730 }
5731 }
5732 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
5733 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
5734 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
5735 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
5736 Match = false;
5737 break;
5738 }
5739 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
5740 nullptr);
5741 if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
5742 Match = false;
5743 break;
5744 }
5745 }
Fariborz Jahanian180d76b2014-08-27 16:38:47 +00005746 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005747 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
5748 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
5749 Match = false;
Fariborz Jahanian180d76b2014-08-27 16:38:47 +00005750 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
5751 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
5752 // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
5753 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
5754 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
5755 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
5756 return Methods[b];
5757 }
5758 }
5759 }
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005760
5761 if (Match)
5762 return Method;
5763 }
5764 return nullptr;
5765}
5766
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005767static bool IsNotEnableIfAttr(Attr *A) { return !isa<EnableIfAttr>(A); }
5768
5769EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5770 bool MissingImplicitThis) {
5771 // FIXME: specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> iterates in reverse order, but
5772 // we need to find the first failing one.
5773 if (!Function->hasAttrs())
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005774 return nullptr;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005775 AttrVec Attrs = Function->getAttrs();
5776 AttrVec::iterator E = std::remove_if(Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
5777 IsNotEnableIfAttr);
5778 if (Attrs.begin() == E)
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005779 return nullptr;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005780 std::reverse(Attrs.begin(), E);
5781
5782 SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
5783
5784 // Convert the arguments.
5785 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
5786 bool InitializationFailed = false;
5787 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5788 if (i == 0 && !MissingImplicitThis && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Function) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8336b72014-02-28 05:26:13 +00005789 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)->isStatic() &&
5790 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005791 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
5792 ExprResult R =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005793 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005794 Method, Method);
5795 if (R.isInvalid()) {
5796 InitializationFailed = true;
5797 break;
5798 }
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00005799 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005800 } else {
5801 ExprResult R =
5802 PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
5803 Context,
5804 Function->getParamDecl(i)),
5805 SourceLocation(),
5806 Args[i]);
5807 if (R.isInvalid()) {
5808 InitializationFailed = true;
5809 break;
5810 }
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00005811 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005812 }
5813 }
5814
5815 if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
5816 return cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attrs[0]);
5817
5818 for (AttrVec::iterator I = Attrs.begin(); I != E; ++I) {
5819 APValue Result;
5820 EnableIfAttr *EIA = cast<EnableIfAttr>(*I);
5821 if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
5822 Result, Context, Function,
Craig Topper00bbdcf2014-06-28 23:22:23 +00005823 ArrayRef<const Expr*>(ConvertedArgs.data(),
5824 ConvertedArgs.size())) ||
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005825 !Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) {
5826 return EIA;
5827 }
5828 }
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005829 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005830}
5831
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005832/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
Nick Lewyckyed4265c2013-09-22 10:06:01 +00005833/// the overload candidate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005834void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005835 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005836 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005837 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5838 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005839 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005840 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5841 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005842 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005843 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005844 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005845 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005846 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5847 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005848 else
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005849 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005850 SuppressUserConversions);
5851 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005852 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005853 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5854 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005855 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005856 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005857 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005858 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005859 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5860 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005861 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005862 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005863 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005864 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005865 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005866 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005867}
5868
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005869/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5870/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005871void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005872 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005873 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005874 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005875 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005876 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005877 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005878 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005879
5880 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5881 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005882
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005883 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5884 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5885 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005886 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005887 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005888 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005889 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005890 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005891 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005892 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005893 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005894 Args,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005895 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005896 }
5897}
5898
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005899/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5900/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5901/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5902/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5903/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5904/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005905/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005906void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005907Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005908 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005909 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005910 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005911 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005912 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005913 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005914 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005915 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005916 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5917 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005918
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005919 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5920 return;
5921
Richard Smith8b86f2d2013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005922 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
5923 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
5924 // ignored by overload resolution.
5925 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
5926 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
5927 return;
5928
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005929 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005930 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005931
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005932 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005933 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005934 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005935 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005936 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005937 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005938 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005939
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005940 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005941
5942 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5943 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5944 // list (8.3.5).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005945 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005946 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005947 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005948 return;
5949 }
5950
5951 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5952 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5953 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5954 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5955 // exactly m parameters.
5956 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005957 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005958 // Not enough arguments.
5959 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005960 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005961 return;
5962 }
5963
5964 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005965
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005966 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005967 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5968 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5969 else {
5970 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5971 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005972 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005973 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5974 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005975 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005976 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005977 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005978 return;
5979 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005980 }
5981
5982 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5983 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005984 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005985 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005986 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5987 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5988 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5989 // parameter of F.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00005990 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005991 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005992 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005993 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005994 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5995 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005996 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005997 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005998 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005999 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006000 return;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006001 }
6002 } else {
6003 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6004 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006005 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006006 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006007 }
6008 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006009
6010 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
6011 Candidate.Viable = false;
6012 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6013 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6014 return;
6015 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006016}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006017
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006018/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
6019/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
6020/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006021void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006022Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006023 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006024 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006025 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006026 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006027 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006028 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006029 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00006030 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006031 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
6032 return;
6033
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006034 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006035 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006036 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006037 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006038 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6039 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6040 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6041 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6042 // functions.
Craig Toppere6706e42012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006043 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006044 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006045 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006046 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6047 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006048 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006049 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6050 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
6051 Candidate.Viable = false;
6052 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6053 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6054 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006055 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006056 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006057 Info);
6058 return;
6059 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006060
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006061 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6062 // deduction as a candidate.
6063 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006064 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006065 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006066 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006067 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
6068 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006069}
6070
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006071/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
6072/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
6073/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006074void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006075Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006076 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006077 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006078 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006079 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00006080 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006081 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6082 return;
6083
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006084 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006085 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006086 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006087 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006088 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6089 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6090 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6091 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6092 // functions.
Craig Toppere6706e42012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006093 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006094 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006095 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006096 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6097 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006098 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006099 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006100 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6101 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006102 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006103 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6104 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006105 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006106 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006107 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006108 return;
6109 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006110
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006111 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6112 // deduction as a candidate.
6113 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006114 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00006115 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006116}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006117
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006118/// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
6119/// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
6120/// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
6121///
6122/// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
6123///
6124/// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
6125///
6126/// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
6127/// Objective-C pointer to another.
6128///
6129/// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
6130static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
6131 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
6132 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
6133 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
6134
6135 // Easy case: the types are the same.
6136 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
6137 return true;
6138
6139 // Allow qualification conversions.
6140 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
6141 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
6142 ObjCLifetimeConversion))
6143 return true;
6144
6145 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
6146 // we're done.
6147 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
6148 return false;
6149
6150 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
6151 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
6152 QualType ConvertedType;
6153 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
6154 IncompatibleObjC);
6155}
6156
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006157/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006158/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006159/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006160/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006161/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
6162/// conversion function produces).
6163void
6164Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006165 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006166 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006167 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006168 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6169 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006170 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6171 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00006172 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006173 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6174 return;
6175
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00006176 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
6177 // deduction now.
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00006178 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00006179 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
6180 return;
6181 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6182 }
6183
Richard Smith089c3162013-09-21 21:55:46 +00006184 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
6185 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
6186 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006187 if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
6188 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
6189 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
Richard Smith089c3162013-09-21 21:55:46 +00006190 return;
6191
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006192 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006193 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006194
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006195 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006196 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006197 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006198 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006199 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006200 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006201 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00006202 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00006203 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006204 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006205 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006206
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00006207 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006208 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
6209 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00006210 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006211 //
6212 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6213 // object parameter.
6214 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
6215 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
6216 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
6217 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
6218 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006219
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006220 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006221 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
6222 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006223 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006224
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006225 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006226 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006227 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006228 return;
6229 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006230
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006231 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00006232 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
6233 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
6234 QualType FromCanon
6235 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
6236 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
6237 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
6238 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006239 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00006240 return;
6241 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006242
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006243 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
6244 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
6245 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
6246 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
6247 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
6248 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
6249 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
6250 // well-formed.
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +00006251 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00006252 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00006253 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
6254 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006255 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00006256 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006257
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006258 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
6259 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00006260 Candidate.Viable = false;
6261 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6262 return;
6263 }
6264
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006265 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00006266
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006267 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00006268 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
6269 // allocator).
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006270 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Dmitri Gribenko78852e92013-05-05 20:40:26 +00006271 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00006272 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006273 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006274 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006275 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006276 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6277 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006278
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006279 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006280 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
6281 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006282
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006283 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
6284 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006285 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006286 // shall have exact match rank.
6287 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6288 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
6289 Candidate.Viable = false;
6290 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006291 return;
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006292 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006293
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006294 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
6295 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
6296 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
6297 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
6298 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006299 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006300 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
6301 Candidate.Viable = false;
6302 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006303 return;
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006304 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006305 break;
6306
6307 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
6308 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006309 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006310 return;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006311
6312 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006313 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006314 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
6315 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006316
Craig Topper5fc8fc22014-08-27 06:28:36 +00006317 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006318 Candidate.Viable = false;
6319 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6320 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6321 return;
6322 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006323}
6324
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006325/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
6326/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
6327/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
6328/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
6329/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006330void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006331Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006332 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006333 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006334 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006335 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6336 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006337 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6338 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
6339
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006340 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6341 return;
6342
Craig Toppere6706e42012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006343 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006344 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006345 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006346 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006347 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006348 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006349 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6350 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6351 Candidate.Viable = false;
6352 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6353 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6354 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006355 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006356 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006357 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006358 return;
6359 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006360
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006361 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
6362 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
6363 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006364 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006365 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006366}
6367
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006368/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
6369/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
6370/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
6371/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
6372/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
6373void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006374 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006375 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006376 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006377 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006378 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006379 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006380 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6381 return;
6382
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006383 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006384 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006385
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006386 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006387 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006388 Candidate.Function = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006389 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
6390 Candidate.Viable = true;
6391 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006392 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006393 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006394
6395 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6396 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006397 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006398 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006399 Object->Classify(Context),
6400 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006401 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006402 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006403 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006404 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006405 return;
6406 }
6407
6408 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
6409 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
6410 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006411 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006412 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00006413 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00006414 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006415 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00006416 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006417 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006418 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
6419 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
6420
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006421 // Find the
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006422 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006423
6424 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6425 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6426 // list (8.3.5).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006427 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006428 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006429 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006430 return;
6431 }
6432
6433 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
6434 // we have enough arguments.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006435 if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006436 // Not enough arguments.
6437 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006438 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006439 return;
6440 }
6441
6442 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6443 // arguments.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006444 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006445 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006446 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6447 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6448 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6449 // parameter of F.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006450 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006451 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006452 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006453 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006454 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6455 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006456 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006457 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006458 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006459 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006460 return;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006461 }
6462 } else {
6463 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6464 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6465 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006466 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006467 }
6468 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006469
Craig Topper5fc8fc22014-08-27 06:28:36 +00006470 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006471 Candidate.Viable = false;
6472 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6473 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6474 return;
6475 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006476}
6477
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006478/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
6479/// member functions.
6480///
6481/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6482/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6483/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6484/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6485/// [over.match.oper]).
6486void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6487 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006488 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006489 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6490 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006491 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6492
6493 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6494 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6495 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6496 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6497 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6498 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6499 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6500 // constructed as follows:
6501 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006502
Richard Smith0feaf0c2013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006503 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6504 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6505 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6506 // the set of member candidates is empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006507 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Richard Smith0feaf0c2013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006508 // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6509 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6510 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6511 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006512 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006513
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006514 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6515 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6516 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6517
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006518 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006519 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6520 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006521 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006522 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00006523 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006524 Args.slice(1),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006525 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006526 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006527 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006528}
6529
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006530/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6531/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6532/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006533/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6534/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006535/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6536/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6537/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006538void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006539 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006540 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006541 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6542 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006543 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006544 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006545
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006546 // Add this candidate
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006547 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006548 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
6549 Candidate.Function = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006550 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006551 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006552 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006553 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006554 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6555
6556 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6557 // arguments.
6558 Candidate.Viable = true;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006559 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6560 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006561 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6562 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6563 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6564 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6565 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6566 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006567 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006568 //
6569 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6570 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6571 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6572 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006573 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006574 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006575 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006576 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6577 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006578 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006579 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006580 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006581 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006582 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6583 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006584 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006585 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006586 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006587 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006588 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006589 break;
6590 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006591 }
6592}
6593
Craig Toppercd7b0332013-07-01 06:29:40 +00006594namespace {
6595
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006596/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6597/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6598/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6599/// enumeration types.
6600class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6601 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006602 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006603
6604 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6605 /// built-in candidates.
6606 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6607
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006608 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6609 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6610 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6611
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006612 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6613 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6614 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6615
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006616 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006617 /// candidates.
6618 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006619
6620 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6621 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6622
6623 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6624 /// were present in the candidate set.
6625 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6626
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006627 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6628 /// candidate set.
6629 bool HasNullPtrType;
6630
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006631 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6632 /// candidate type set.
6633 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006634
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006635 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6636 ASTContext &Context;
6637
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006638 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6639 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006640 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006641
6642public:
6643 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006644 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006645
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006646 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006647 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6648 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006649 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006650 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6651 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006652
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006653 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006654 SourceLocation Loc,
6655 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006656 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6657 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006658
6659 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6660 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6661
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006662 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006663 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6664
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006665 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6666 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6667
6668 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6669 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6670
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006671 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6672 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6673
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006674 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006675 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006676
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006677 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6678 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006679
6680 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6681 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006682 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006683};
6684
Craig Toppercd7b0332013-07-01 06:29:40 +00006685} // end anonymous namespace
6686
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006687/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006688/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6689/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6690/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6691/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6692/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6693/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006694///
6695/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006696bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006697BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6698 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006699
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006700 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006701 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006702 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006703
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006704 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006705 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006706 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006707 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006708 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6709 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6710 buildObjCPtr = true;
6711 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006712 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006713 }
6714
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006715 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6716 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6717 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6718 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6719 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6720 return true;
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006721
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006722 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006723 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6724 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006725
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006726 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6727 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6728 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006729 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006730 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006731
6732 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6733 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6734 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6735 (!hasRestrict ||
6736 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6737 continue;
6738
6739 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006740 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006741
6742 // Build qualified pointer type.
6743 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006744 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006745 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006746 else
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006747 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6748
6749 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6750 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006751 }
6752
6753 return true;
6754}
6755
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006756/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6757/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6758/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6759/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6760/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6761/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6762/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006763///
6764/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006765bool
6766BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6767 QualType Ty) {
6768 // Insert this type.
6769 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6770 return false;
6771
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006772 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6773 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006774
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006775 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006776 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6777 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6778 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6779 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6780 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6781 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006782 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6783
6784 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6785 // qualifiers.
6786 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6787 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6788 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006789
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006790 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006791 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6792 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006793 }
6794
6795 return true;
6796}
6797
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006798/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6799/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006800/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6801/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006802/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6803/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6804/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6805/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006806void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006807BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006808 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006809 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006810 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6811 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006812 // Only deal with canonical types.
6813 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6814
6815 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6816 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006817 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006818 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6819
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006820 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6821 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6822 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6823
6824 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006825 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006826
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006827 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6828 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6829 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6830
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006831 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6832 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6833 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6834
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006835 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6836 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6837 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006838 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6839 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006840 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006841 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006842 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6843 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6844 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6845 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006846 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006847 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006848 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006849 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006850 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6851 // extension.
6852 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006853 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006854 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6855 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006856 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6857 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6858 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6859 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006860
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006861 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006862 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6863 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6864 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6865 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6866 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006867 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6868 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6869 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006870
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006871 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6872 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6873 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6874 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006875
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006876 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6877 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6878 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6879 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006880 }
6881 }
6882 }
6883}
6884
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006885/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6886/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6887/// given type to the candidate set.
6888static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6889 QualType T,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006890 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006891 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6892 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006893
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006894 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6895 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6896 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006897 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006898 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006899
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006900 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6901 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006902 ParamTypes[0]
6903 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006904 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006905 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006906 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006907 }
6908}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006909
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006910/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6911/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006912static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6913 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6914 const RecordType *TyRec;
6915 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6916 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006917 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006918 else
6919 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6920 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006921 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006922 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6923 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6924 return VRQuals;
6925 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006926
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006927 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006928 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6929 return VRQuals;
6930
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006931 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6932 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6933 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006934
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006935 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6936 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006937 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6938 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6939 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6940 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006941 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6942 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6943 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6944 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6945 // as see them.
6946 bool done = false;
6947 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006948 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6949 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006950 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6951 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006952 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006953 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6954 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6955 else
6956 done = true;
6957 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6958 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006959 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6960 return VRQuals;
6961 }
6962 }
6963 }
6964 return VRQuals;
6965}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006966
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006967namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006968
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006969/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6970/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6971/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6972/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6973class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006974 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6975 Sema &S;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006976 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006977 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006978 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006979 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006980 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006981
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006982 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6983 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006984 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6985 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006986 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006987 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006988 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006989 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006990 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006991 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6992 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006993
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006994 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6995 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6996 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6997 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6998 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6999 // Start of promoted types.
7000 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
7001 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
7002 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00007003
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007004 // Start of integral types.
7005 &ASTContext::IntTy,
7006 &ASTContext::LongTy,
7007 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007008 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007009 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
7010 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
7011 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007012 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007013 // End of promoted types.
7014
7015 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
7016 &ASTContext::CharTy,
7017 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
7018 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
7019 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
7020 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
7021 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
7022 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
7023 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
7024 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007025 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007026 };
7027 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
7028 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007029
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007030 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
7031 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
7032 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
7033 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
7034 // The rules are basically:
7035 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
7036 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
7037 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
7038 // - use the larger type
7039 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
7040 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
7041 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
7042 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
7043 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007044 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007045 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007046 Dep=-1,
7047 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007048 };
Nuno Lopes9af6b032012-04-21 14:45:25 +00007049 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007050 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007051/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
7052/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
7053/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
7054/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
7055/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
7056/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
7057/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
7058/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
7059/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
7060/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
7061/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007062 };
7063
7064 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
7065 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
7066 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
7067
7068 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007069 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007070
7071 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
7072 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007073 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
7074 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007075 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
7076 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
7077
7078 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
7079 if (LW > RW) return LT;
7080 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
7081
7082 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
7083 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
7084 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
7085 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
7086 }
7087
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00007088 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
7089 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007090 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007091 bool HasVolatile,
7092 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007093 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7094 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
7095 S.Context.IntTy
7096 };
7097
7098 // Non-volatile version.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007099 if (Args.size() == 1)
7100 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007101 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007102 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007103
7104 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
7105 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
7106 if (HasVolatile) {
7107 ParamTypes[0] =
7108 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7109 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007110 if (Args.size() == 1)
7111 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007112 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007113 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007114 }
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007115
7116 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
7117 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
7118 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
7119 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
7120 ParamTypes[0]
7121 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7122 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007123 if (Args.size() == 1)
7124 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007125 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007126 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007127
7128 if (HasVolatile) {
7129 ParamTypes[0]
7130 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7131 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
7132 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7133 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007134 if (Args.size() == 1)
7135 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007136 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007137 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007138 }
7139 }
7140
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007141 }
7142
7143public:
7144 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007145 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007146 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007147 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007148 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007149 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007150 : S(S), Args(Args),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007151 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007152 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
7153 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007154 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
7155 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
7156 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007157 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007158 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007159 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007160 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007161 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007162 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
7163 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007164 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007165 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007166 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007167 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
7168 }
7169
7170 // C++ [over.built]p3:
7171 //
7172 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
7173 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
7174 // functions of the form
7175 //
7176 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
7177 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
7178 //
7179 // C++ [over.built]p4:
7180 //
7181 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
7182 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
7183 // candidate operator functions of the form
7184 //
7185 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
7186 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
7187 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007188 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7189 return;
7190
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007191 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
7192 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
7193 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007194 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007195 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
7196 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007197 }
7198 }
7199
7200 // C++ [over.built]p5:
7201 //
7202 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7203 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
7204 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7205 //
7206 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
7207 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
7208 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
7209 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
7210 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
7211 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7212 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7213 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7214 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7215 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007216 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007217 continue;
7218
7219 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007220 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7221 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
7222 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7223 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007224 }
7225 }
7226
7227 // C++ [over.built]p6:
7228 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
7229 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7230 //
7231 // T& operator*(T*);
7232 //
7233 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007234 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00007235 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007236 // T& operator*(T*);
7237 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
7238 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7239 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7240 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7241 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7242 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7243 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007244 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
7245 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007246
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00007247 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
7248 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
7249 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007250
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007251 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007252 &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007253 }
7254 }
7255
7256 // C++ [over.built]p9:
7257 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
7258 // operator functions of the form
7259 //
7260 // T operator+(T);
7261 // T operator-(T);
7262 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007263 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7264 return;
7265
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007266 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7267 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007268 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007269 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007270 }
7271
7272 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
7273 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7274 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7275 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7276 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7277 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007278 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007279 }
7280 }
7281
7282 // C++ [over.built]p8:
7283 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
7284 // the form
7285 //
7286 // T* operator+(T*);
7287 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
7288 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7289 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7290 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7291 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7292 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007293 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007294 }
7295 }
7296
7297 // C++ [over.built]p10:
7298 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
7299 // operator functions of the form
7300 //
7301 // T operator~(T);
7302 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007303 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7304 return;
7305
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007306 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7307 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007308 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007309 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007310 }
7311
7312 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
7313 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7314 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7315 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7316 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7317 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007318 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007319 }
7320 }
7321
7322 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
7323 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
7324 // functions of the form
7325 //
7326 // bool operator==(T,T);
7327 // bool operator!=(T,T);
7328 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
7329 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7330 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7331
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007332 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007333 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7334 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7335 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7336 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
7337 ++MemPtr) {
7338 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7339 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7340 continue;
7341
7342 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007343 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007344 }
7345 }
7346 }
7347
7348 // C++ [over.built]p15:
7349 //
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007350 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
7351 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007352 //
7353 // bool operator<(T, T);
7354 // bool operator>(T, T);
7355 // bool operator<=(T, T);
7356 // bool operator>=(T, T);
7357 // bool operator==(T, T);
7358 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007359 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman14f082b2012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007360 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7361 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7362 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7363 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7364 // candidate.
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007365 //
Eli Friedman14f082b2012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007366 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7367 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7368 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7369 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007370 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7371 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7372 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7373 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7374
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007375 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007376 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7377 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7378 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7379 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7380 C != CEnd; ++C) {
7381 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7382 continue;
7383
Eli Friedman14f082b2012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007384 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
7385 continue;
7386
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007387 QualType FirstParamType =
7388 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7389 QualType SecondParamType =
7390 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7391
7392 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
7393 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
7394 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
7395 continue;
7396
7397 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
7398 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
7399 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
7400 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
7401 }
7402 }
7403 }
7404
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007405 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7406 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7407
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007408 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007409 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7410 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7411 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7412 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7413 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7414 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7415 continue;
7416
7417 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007418 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007419 }
7420 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7421 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7422 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7423 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7424 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
7425
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007426 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
7427 // candidate exists.
7428 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
7429 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
7430 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007431 continue;
7432
7433 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007434 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007435 }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007436
7437 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7438 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7439 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007440 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007441 NullPtrTy))) {
7442 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007443 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args,
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007444 CandidateSet);
7445 }
7446 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007447 }
7448 }
7449
7450 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7451 //
7452 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
7453 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7454 //
7455 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7456 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
7457 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7458 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7459 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
7460 //
7461 // C++ [over.built]p14:
7462 //
7463 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
7464 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7465 //
7466 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7467 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7468 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7469 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7470
7471 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
7472 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
7473 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7474 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7475 };
7476 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7477 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7478 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7479 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007480 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7481 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7482 continue;
7483
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007484 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7485 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7486 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7487 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007488 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007489 }
7490 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7491 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7492 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7493 continue;
7494
7495 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7496 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007497 Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007498 }
7499 }
7500 }
7501 }
7502
7503 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7504 //
7505 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7506 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7507 //
7508 // LR operator*(L, R);
7509 // LR operator/(L, R);
7510 // LR operator+(L, R);
7511 // LR operator-(L, R);
7512 // bool operator<(L, R);
7513 // bool operator>(L, R);
7514 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7515 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7516 // bool operator==(L, R);
7517 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7518 //
7519 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7520 // between types L and R.
7521 //
7522 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7523 //
7524 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7525 // candidate operator functions of the form
7526 //
7527 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7528 //
7529 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7530 // between types L and R.
7531 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7532 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007533 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7534 return;
7535
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007536 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7537 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7538 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7539 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007540 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7541 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007542 QualType Result =
7543 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007544 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007545 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007546 }
7547 }
7548
7549 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7550 // conditional operator for vector types.
7551 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7552 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7553 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7554 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7555 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7556 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7557 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7558 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7559 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7560 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7561 if (!isComparison) {
7562 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7563 Result = *Vec1;
7564 else
7565 Result = *Vec2;
7566 }
7567
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007568 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007569 }
7570 }
7571 }
7572
7573 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7574 //
7575 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7576 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7577 //
7578 // LR operator%(L, R);
7579 // LR operator&(L, R);
7580 // LR operator^(L, R);
7581 // LR operator|(L, R);
7582 // L operator<<(L, R);
7583 // L operator>>(L, R);
7584 //
7585 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7586 // between types L and R.
7587 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007588 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7589 return;
7590
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007591 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7592 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7593 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7594 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007595 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7596 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007597 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7598 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007599 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007600 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007601 }
7602 }
7603 }
7604
7605 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7606 //
7607 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7608 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7609 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7610 //
7611 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7612 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7613 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7614 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7615
7616 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7617 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7618 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7619 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7620 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7621 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7622 continue;
7623
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007624 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007625 }
7626
7627 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7628 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7629 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7630 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7631 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7632 continue;
7633
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007634 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007635 }
7636 }
7637 }
7638
7639 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7640 //
7641 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7642 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7643 // of the form
7644 //
7645 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7646 //
7647 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7648 //
7649 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7650 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7651 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7652 //
7653 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7654 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7655 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7656 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7657 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7658
7659 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7660 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7661 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7662 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7663 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7664 if (isEqualOp)
7665 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007666 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7667 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007668
7669 // non-volatile version
7670 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7671 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7672 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7673 };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007674 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007675 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7676
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007677 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7678 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7679 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007680 // volatile version
7681 ParamTypes[0] =
7682 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007683 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007684 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7685 }
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007686
7687 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7688 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7689 // restrict version
7690 ParamTypes[0]
7691 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007692 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007693 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7694
7695 if (NeedVolatile) {
7696 // volatile restrict version
7697 ParamTypes[0]
7698 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7699 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7700 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7701 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007702 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007703 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7704 }
7705 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007706 }
7707
7708 if (isEqualOp) {
7709 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7710 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7711 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7712 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7713 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7714 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7715 continue;
7716
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007717 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7718 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7719 *Ptr,
7720 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007721
7722 // non-volatile version
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007723 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007724 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7725
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007726 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7727 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7728 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007729 // volatile version
7730 ParamTypes[0] =
7731 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007732 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7733 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007734 }
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007735
7736 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7737 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7738 // restrict version
7739 ParamTypes[0]
7740 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007741 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7742 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007743
7744 if (NeedVolatile) {
7745 // volatile restrict version
7746 ParamTypes[0]
7747 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7748 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7749 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7750 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007751 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7752 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007753 }
7754 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007755 }
7756 }
7757 }
7758
7759 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7760 //
7761 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7762 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7763 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7764 // the form
7765 //
7766 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7767 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7768 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7769 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7770 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7771 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007772 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7773 return;
7774
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007775 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7776 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7777 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7778 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007779 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007780
7781 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7782 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007783 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007784 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007785 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7786
7787 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7788 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7789 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007790 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007791 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007792 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007793 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7794 }
7795 }
7796 }
7797
7798 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7799 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7800 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7801 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7802 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7803 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7804 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7805 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7806 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7807 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7808 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7809 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7810 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007811 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007812 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7813
7814 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7815 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7816 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7817 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007818 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007819 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7820 }
7821 }
7822 }
7823 }
7824
7825 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7826 //
7827 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7828 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7829 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7830 //
7831 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7832 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7833 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7834 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7835 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7836 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7837 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007838 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7839 return;
7840
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007841 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7842 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7843 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7844 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007845 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007846
7847 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7848 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007849 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007850 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007851 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7852 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007853 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007854 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7855 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007856 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007857 }
7858 }
7859 }
7860 }
7861
7862 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7863 //
7864 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7865 //
7866 // bool operator!(bool);
7867 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7868 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7869 void addExclaimOverload() {
7870 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007871 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007872 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7873 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7874 }
7875 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7876 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007877 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007878 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7879 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7880 }
7881
7882 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7883 //
7884 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7885 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7886 //
7887 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7888 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7889 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7890 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7891 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7892 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7893 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7894 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7895 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7896 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7897 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7898 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007899 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7900 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007901
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007902 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7903
7904 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007905 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007906 }
7907
7908 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7909 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7910 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7911 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7912 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7913 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007914 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7915 continue;
7916
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007917 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7918
7919 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007920 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007921 }
7922 }
7923
7924 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7925 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7926 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7927 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7928 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7929 //
7930 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7931 //
7932 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7933 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7934 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7935 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7936 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7937 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7938 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7939 QualType C1;
7940 QualifierCollector Q1;
7941 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7942 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7943 continue;
7944 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7945 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7946 // volatile/restrict type.
7947 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7948 continue;
7949 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7950 continue;
7951 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7952 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7953 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7954 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7955 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7956 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7957 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7958 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7959 break;
7960 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7961 // build CV12 T&
7962 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7963 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7964 T.isVolatileQualified())
7965 continue;
7966 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7967 T.isRestrictQualified())
7968 continue;
7969 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7970 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007971 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007972 }
7973 }
7974 }
7975
7976 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7977 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7978 // therefore added as binary.
7979 //
7980 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7981 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7982 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7983 //
7984 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7985 //
7986 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7987 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7988 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7989
7990 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7991 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7992 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7993 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7994 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7995 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7996 continue;
7997
7998 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007999 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008000 }
8001
8002 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8003 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8004 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8005 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8006 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
8007 continue;
8008
8009 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008010 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008011 }
8012
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00008013 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008014 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8015 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8016 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8017 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8018 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
8019 continue;
8020
8021 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
8022 continue;
8023
8024 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008025 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008026 }
8027 }
8028 }
8029 }
8030};
8031
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008032} // end anonymous namespace
8033
8034/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
8035/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
8036/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
8037/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
8038/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
Robert Wilhelm16e94b92013-08-09 18:02:13 +00008039void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8040 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8041 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8042 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008043 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
8044 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008045 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
8046 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00008047 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8048 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008049 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00008050 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008051
8052 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
8053 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008054 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008055 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00008056 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
8057 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
8058 OpLoc,
8059 true,
8060 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
8061 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
8062 Op == OO_PipePipe),
8063 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008064 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
8065 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
8066 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
8067 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
8068 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00008069 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008070
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008071 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
8072 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00008073 //
8074 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
8075 // 'bool' overloads.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008076 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00008077 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008078 return;
8079
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008080 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008081 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008082 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008083 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008084 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
8085
8086 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008087 switch (Op) {
8088 case OO_None:
8089 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008090 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008091
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008092 case OO_New:
8093 case OO_Delete:
8094 case OO_Array_New:
8095 case OO_Array_Delete:
8096 case OO_Call:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008097 llvm_unreachable(
8098 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008099
8100 case OO_Comma:
8101 case OO_Arrow:
8102 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8103 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8104 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008105 break;
8106
8107 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008108 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008109 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00008110 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008111
8112 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008113 if (Args.size() == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008114 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00008115 } else {
8116 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
8117 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8118 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008119 break;
8120
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008121 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008122 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008123 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
8124 else
8125 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8126 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008127
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008128 case OO_Slash:
8129 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00008130 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008131
8132 case OO_PlusPlus:
8133 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008134 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8135 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008136 break;
8137
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00008138 case OO_EqualEqual:
8139 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008140 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00008141 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00008142
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008143 case OO_Less:
8144 case OO_Greater:
8145 case OO_LessEqual:
8146 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00008147 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00008148 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
8149 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008150
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008151 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008152 case OO_Caret:
8153 case OO_Pipe:
8154 case OO_LessLess:
8155 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008156 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008157 break;
8158
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008159 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008160 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008161 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8162 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8163 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
8164 break;
8165
8166 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8167 break;
8168
8169 case OO_Tilde:
8170 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
8171 break;
8172
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008173 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008174 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00008175 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008176
8177 case OO_PlusEqual:
8178 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008179 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008180 // Fall through.
8181
8182 case OO_StarEqual:
8183 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008184 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008185 break;
8186
8187 case OO_PercentEqual:
8188 case OO_LessLessEqual:
8189 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
8190 case OO_AmpEqual:
8191 case OO_CaretEqual:
8192 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008193 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008194 break;
8195
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008196 case OO_Exclaim:
8197 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008198 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008199
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008200 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008201 case OO_PipePipe:
8202 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008203 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008204
8205 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008206 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008207 break;
8208
8209 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008210 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008211 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008212
8213 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008214 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00008215 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8216 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008217 }
8218}
8219
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008220/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
8221/// to the set of overloading candidates.
8222///
8223/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
8224/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
8225/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
8226/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008227void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008228Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00008229 SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008230 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008231 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008232 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +00008233 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008234 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008235
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00008236 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
8237 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
8238 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
8239 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
8240 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
8241 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
8242
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008243 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00008244 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008245
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00008246 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00008247 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
8248 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8249 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008250 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008251 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008252 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008253 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008254 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00008255
8256 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
8257 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008258 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008259 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008260 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008261 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008262 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008263
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008264 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
8265 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008266 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008267 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008268 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008269 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008270 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008271}
8272
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008273/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
8274/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008275bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008276isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008277 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
8278 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008279 SourceLocation Loc,
8280 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008281 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
8282 // functions.
8283 if (!Cand2.Viable)
8284 return Cand1.Viable;
8285 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
8286 return false;
8287
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008288 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8289 //
8290 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
8291 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
8292 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
8293 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
8294 unsigned StartArg = 0;
8295 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
8296 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008297
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008298 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008299 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
8300 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008301 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008302 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
8303 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008304 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008305 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008306 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8307 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008308 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
8309 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8310 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8311 HasBetterConversion = true;
8312 break;
8313
8314 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8315 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8316 return false;
8317
8318 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8319 // Do nothing.
8320 break;
8321 }
8322 }
8323
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008324 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008325 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008326 if (HasBetterConversion)
8327 return true;
8328
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008329 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
8330 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
8331 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
8332 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
8333 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
8334 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008335 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008336 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008337 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00008338 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
8339 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
8340 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
8341 // pointer or block.
Richard Smithec2748a2014-05-17 04:36:39 +00008342 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
8343 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8344 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8345 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
8346 Cand1.FinalConversion,
8347 Cand2.FinalConversion);
Richard Smith6fdeaab2014-05-17 01:58:45 +00008348
Richard Smithec2748a2014-05-17 04:36:39 +00008349 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8350 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Richard Smith6fdeaab2014-05-17 01:58:45 +00008351
8352 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
8353 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
8354 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
8355 }
8356
8357 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
8358 // specialization, or, if not that,
8359 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
8360 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8361 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
8362 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8363 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
8364 return Cand2IsSpecialization;
8365
8366 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
8367 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
8368 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
8369 // if not that,
8370 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
8371 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
8372 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8373 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8374 Loc,
8375 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
8376 : TPOC_Call,
8377 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments,
8378 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments))
8379 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008380 }
8381
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008382 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
8383 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
8384 (Cand1.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>() ||
8385 Cand2.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>())) {
8386 // FIXME: The next several lines are just
8387 // specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> but going in declaration order,
8388 // instead of reverse order which is how they're stored in the AST.
8389 AttrVec Cand1Attrs;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008390 if (Cand1.Function->hasAttrs()) {
8391 Cand1Attrs = Cand1.Function->getAttrs();
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008392 Cand1Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end(),
8393 IsNotEnableIfAttr),
8394 Cand1Attrs.end());
8395 std::reverse(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008396 }
8397
8398 AttrVec Cand2Attrs;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008399 if (Cand2.Function->hasAttrs()) {
8400 Cand2Attrs = Cand2.Function->getAttrs();
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008401 Cand2Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end(),
8402 IsNotEnableIfAttr),
8403 Cand2Attrs.end());
8404 std::reverse(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008405 }
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008406
8407 // Candidate 1 is better if it has strictly more attributes and
8408 // the common sequence is identical.
8409 if (Cand1Attrs.size() <= Cand2Attrs.size())
8410 return false;
8411
8412 auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin();
8413 for (auto &Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) {
8414 auto &Cand1A = *Cand1I++;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008415 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008416 cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID,
8417 S.getASTContext(), true);
8418 cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID,
8419 S.getASTContext(), true);
Nick Lewyckyd950ae72014-01-21 01:30:30 +00008420 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008421 return false;
8422 }
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008423
8424 return true;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008425 }
8426
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008427 return false;
8428}
8429
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008430/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008431/// within an overload candidate set.
8432///
James Dennettffad8b72012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008433/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008434/// which overload resolution occurs.
8435///
James Dennettffad8b72012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008436/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
8437/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008438///
8439/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008440OverloadingResult
8441OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008442 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008443 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008444 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008445 Best = end();
8446 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8447 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008448 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008449 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008450 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008451 }
8452
8453 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008454 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008455 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
8456
8457 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
8458 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008459 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008460 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008461 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008462 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008463 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008464 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008465 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008466 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008467 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008468
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008469 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008470 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008471 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
8472 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008473 return OR_Deleted;
8474
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008475 return OR_Success;
8476}
8477
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008478namespace {
8479
8480enum OverloadCandidateKind {
8481 oc_function,
8482 oc_method,
8483 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008484 oc_function_template,
8485 oc_method_template,
8486 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008487 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
8488 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008489 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008490 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008491 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008492 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008493};
8494
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008495OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8496 FunctionDecl *Fn,
8497 std::string &Description) {
8498 bool isTemplate = false;
8499
8500 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
8501 isTemplate = true;
8502 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8503 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
8504 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008505
8506 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008507 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008508 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008509
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008510 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8511 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8512
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008513 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8514 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8515
8516 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8517 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8518
8519 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8520 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8521 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008522 }
8523
8524 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8525 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8526 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008527 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008528 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008529
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008530 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8531 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8532
Douglas Gregor12695102012-02-10 08:36:38 +00008533 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8534 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8535
8536 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8537 return oc_method;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008538 }
8539
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008540 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008541}
8542
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008543void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *Fn) {
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008544 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8545 if (!Ctor) return;
8546
8547 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8548 if (!Ctor) return;
8549
8550 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8551}
8552
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008553} // end anonymous namespace
8554
8555// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008556void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008557 std::string FnDesc;
8558 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008559 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8560 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8561 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8562 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008563 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008564}
8565
Nick Lewyckyed4265c2013-09-22 10:06:01 +00008566// Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008567// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008568void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008569 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8570
8571 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8572 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8573
8574 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8575 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8576 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8577 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8578 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008579 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008580 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8581 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008582 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008583 }
8584 }
8585}
8586
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008587/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8588/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8589/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008590void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8591 Sema &S,
8592 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8593 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8594 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8595 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay641bd892012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008596 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8597 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8598 // refactoring here.
8599 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8600 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8601 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8602 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8603 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8604 break;
8605 ++CandsShown;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008606 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008607 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay641bd892012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008608 if (I != E)
8609 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008610}
8611
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008612namespace {
8613
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008614void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8615 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8616 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008617 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8618 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8619
8620 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8621 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8622 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008623 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008624 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008625 if (I == 0)
8626 isObjectArgument = true;
8627 else
8628 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008629 }
8630
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008631 std::string FnDesc;
8632 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8633
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008634 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8635 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8636 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008637
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008638 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008639 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008640 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8641 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8642 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008643 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008644
8645 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8646 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8647 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8648 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008649 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008650 return;
8651 }
8652
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008653 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8654 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008655 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8656 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8657 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8658 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8659 else {
8660 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8661 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8662 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8663 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8664 }
8665
8666 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8667 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008668 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8669 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8670
8671 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8672 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8673 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8674 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8675 << FromTy
8676 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8677 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008678 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008679 return;
8680 }
8681
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008682 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscff00d92011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008683 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008684 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8685 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8686 << FromTy
8687 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8688 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8689 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8690 return;
8691 }
8692
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008693 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8694 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8695 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8696 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8697 << FromTy
8698 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8699 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8700 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8701 return;
8702 }
8703
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008704 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8705 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8706
8707 if (isObjectArgument) {
8708 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8709 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8710 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8711 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8712 } else {
8713 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8714 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8715 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8716 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8717 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008718 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008719 return;
8720 }
8721
Sebastian Redla72462c2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008722 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8723 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8724 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8725 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8726 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8727 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8728 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8729 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8730 return;
8731 }
8732
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008733 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8734 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8735 // the failure.
8736 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8737 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8738 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8739 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8740 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8741 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8742 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8743 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008744 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008745 return;
8746 }
8747
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008748 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008749 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008750 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8751 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8752 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8753 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8754 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8755 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008756 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008757 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008758 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008759 }
8760 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8761 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8762 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8763 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8764 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8765 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8766 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8767 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8768 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008769 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8770 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain9ea8f7e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008771 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8772 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8773 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8774 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8775 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8776 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8777 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8778 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain9ea8f7e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008779 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8780 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8781 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8782 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8783 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8784 return;
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008785 }
Kaelyn Uhrain9ea8f7e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008786 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008787
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008788 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008789 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008790 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008791 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8792 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008793 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008794 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008795 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008796 return;
8797 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008798
Fariborz Jahaniana644f9c2011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008799 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8800 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8801 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8802 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8803 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8804 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8805 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8806 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8807 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8808 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8809 return;
8810 }
8811 }
8812
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008813 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8814 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8815 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008816 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008817 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8818 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8819
8820 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer490afa62012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008821 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8822 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008823 FDiag << *HI;
8824 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8825
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008826 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008827}
8828
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008829/// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
8830/// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
8831/// over a candidate in any candidate set.
8832bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8833 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008834 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008835 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008836
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008837 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008838 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008839 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8840 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8841 // Just don't report anything.
8842 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8843 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008844 return true;
8845
8846 if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
8847 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8848 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8849 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
8850 } else {
8851 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8852 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8853 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
8854 }
8855
8856 return false;
8857}
8858
8859/// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
8860void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, Decl *D, unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8861 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
8862 "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
8863 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
8864 " or too few arguments");
8865
8866 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
8867
8868 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8869 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8870 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008871
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008872 // at least / at most / exactly
8873 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8874 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008875 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
8876 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008877 mode = 0; // "at least"
8878 else
8879 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8880 modeCount = MinParams;
8881 } else {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008882 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008883 mode = 1; // "at most"
8884 else
8885 mode = 2; // "exactly"
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008886 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008887 }
8888
8889 std::string Description;
8890 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8891
Richard Smith10ff50d2012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008892 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8893 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00008894 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
8895 << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
Richard Smith10ff50d2012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008896 else
8897 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00008898 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
8899 << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008900 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008901}
8902
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008903/// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
8904void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8905 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8906 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
8907 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
8908}
Larisse Voufo47c08452013-07-19 22:53:23 +00008909
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008910TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
8911 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))
8912 return FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
8913 else if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Templated))
8914 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate();
8915
8916 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
8917 " for bad deduction diagnosis");
8918}
8919
8920/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8921void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, Decl *Templated,
8922 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
8923 unsigned NumArgs) {
8924 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008925 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8926 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8927 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8928 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008929 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008930 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8931 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8932
8933 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008934 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008935 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8936 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8937 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8938 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008939 return;
8940 }
8941
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008942 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8943 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8944 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8945
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008946 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008947
8948 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8949 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008950 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008951 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008952 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008953 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8954
8955 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8956 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8957 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8958 // done on dependent types).
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008959 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008960
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008961 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8962 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
8963 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008964 return;
8965 }
8966
8967 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008968 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008969 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008970 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008971 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008972 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008973 which = 1;
8974 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008975 which = 2;
8976 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008977
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008978 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8979 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
8980 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8981 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8982 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008983 return;
8984 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008985
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008986 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008987 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008988 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008989 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008990 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008991 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008992 else {
8993 int index = 0;
8994 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8995 index = TTP->getIndex();
8996 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8997 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8998 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8999 else
9000 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009001 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00009002 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009003 << (index + 1);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00009004 }
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009005 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00009006 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009007
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00009008 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9009 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009010 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Templated, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00009011 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00009012
9013 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009014 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9015 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
9016 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00009017 return;
9018
9019 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009020 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009021 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009022 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009023 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009024 TemplateArgString = " ";
9025 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009026 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009027 }
9028
Richard Smith6f8d2c62012-05-09 05:17:00 +00009029 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009030 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
Richard Smith6f8d2c62012-05-09 05:17:00 +00009031 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
9032 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
9033 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
9034 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
9035 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
9036 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
9037 return;
9038 }
9039
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009040 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
9041 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
9042 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009043 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009044 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith6f8d2c62012-05-09 05:17:00 +00009045 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009046 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
9047 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
9048 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
9049 }
9050
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009051 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9052 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
9053 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
9054 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00009055 return;
9056 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009057
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +00009058 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009059 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(DeductionFailure.getExpr());
9060 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +00009061 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009062 << R.Expression->getName();
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +00009063 return;
9064 }
9065
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009066 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009067 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009068 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
9069 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009070 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
9071 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
9072 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
9073 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
9074 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
9075 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
9076 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
9077 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
9078 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
9079 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since:
9080 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
9081 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
9082 // name for types, not decls.
9083 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009084 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009085 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
9086 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
9087 return;
9088 }
9089 }
9090 }
Faisal Vali2b391ab2013-09-26 19:54:12 +00009091 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
9092 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
9093 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
9094 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009095 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9096 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
9097 << FirstTA << SecondTA;
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009098 return;
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009099 }
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009100 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
9101 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009102 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009103 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
9104 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009105 return;
9106 }
9107}
9108
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009109/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
9110void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned NumArgs) {
9111 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
9112 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
9113 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
9114 return;
9115 }
9116 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->Function, // pattern
9117 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs);
9118}
9119
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009120/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
9121void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9122 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9123 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9124
9125 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
9126 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
9127
9128 std::string FnDesc;
9129 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
9130
9131 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
9132 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
9133}
9134
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00009135void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9136 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9137 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
9138
9139 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
9140 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
9141 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
9142}
9143
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009144/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
9145/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
9146///
9147/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
9148/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
9149/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
9150/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
9151/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
9152/// overload.
9153///
9154/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
9155/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
9156/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009157void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009158 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00009159 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9160
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009161 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00009162 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
9163 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009164 std::string FnDesc;
9165 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00009166
9167 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith6f1e2c62012-04-02 20:59:25 +00009168 << FnKind << FnDesc
9169 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00009170 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009171 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009172 }
9173
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009174 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
9175 if (Cand->Viable) {
9176 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9177 return;
9178 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009179
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009180 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
9181 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
9182 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
9183 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009184
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009185 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009186 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009187
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009188 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
9189 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00009190 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009191 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009192
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009193 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
9194 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009195 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009196 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
9197 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009198
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009199 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
9200 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
9201 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
9202 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009203 }
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009204
9205 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
9206 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00009207
9208 case ovl_fail_enable_if:
9209 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009210 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009211}
9212
9213void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9214 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
9215 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
9216 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
9217 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
9218 bool isLValueReference = false;
9219 bool isRValueReference = false;
9220 bool isPointer = false;
9221 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9222 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
9223 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9224 isLValueReference = true;
9225 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9226 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
9227 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9228 isRValueReference = true;
9229 }
9230 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9231 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9232 isPointer = true;
9233 }
9234 // Desugar down to a function type.
9235 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
9236 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
9237 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
9238 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
9239 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
9240
9241 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
9242 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00009243 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009244}
9245
9246void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie1d202a62012-10-08 01:11:04 +00009247 StringRef Opc,
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009248 SourceLocation OpLoc,
9249 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009250 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009251 std::string TypeStr("operator");
9252 TypeStr += Opc;
9253 TypeStr += "(";
9254 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009255 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009256 TypeStr += ")";
9257 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9258 } else {
9259 TypeStr += ", ";
9260 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
9261 TypeStr += ")";
9262 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9263 }
9264}
9265
9266void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9267 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009268 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009269 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
9270 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009271 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
9272 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
9273
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009274 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00009275 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009276 }
9277}
9278
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009279static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009280 if (Cand->Function)
9281 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00009282 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009283 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
9284 return SourceLocation();
9285}
9286
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009287static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth73fddfe2011-09-10 00:51:24 +00009288 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009289 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009290 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00009291
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +00009292 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009293 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
9294 return 1;
9295
9296 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
9297 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
9298 return 2;
9299
9300 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
9301 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009302 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009303 return 3;
9304
9305 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
9306 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
9307 return 4;
9308
9309 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
9310 return 5;
9311
9312 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9313 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
9314 return 6;
9315 }
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00009316 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009317}
9318
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009319struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
9320 Sema &S;
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009321 size_t NumArgs;
9322
9323 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S, size_t nArgs)
9324 : S(S), NumArgs(nArgs) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009325
9326 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
9327 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00009328 // Fast-path this check.
9329 if (L == R) return false;
9330
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009331 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009332 if (L->Viable) {
9333 if (!R->Viable) return true;
9334
9335 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
9336 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
9337 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009338 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
9339 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009340 } else if (R->Viable)
9341 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009342
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009343 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009344
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009345 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
9346 if (!L->Viable) {
9347 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
9348 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009349 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
9350 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9351 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
Kaelyn Takata50c4ffc2014-05-07 00:43:38 +00009352 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9353 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9354 if (LDist == RDist) {
9355 if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind)
9356 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
9357 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
9358 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
9359 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
9360 // than there were arguments given.
9361 return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
9362 }
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009363 return LDist < RDist;
9364 }
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009365 return false;
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009366 }
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009367 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9368 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
9369 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009370
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009371 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
9372 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
9373 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
9374 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9375 return true;
9376
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009377 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
9378 // comes first.
9379 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9380 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9381 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
9382 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00009383 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009384 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
9385 return true;
9386 else
9387 return false;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00009388 }
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009389
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009390 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
9391 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009392 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009393
9394 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00009395 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009396 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009397 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
9398 L->Conversions[I],
9399 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009400 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9401 leftBetter++;
9402 break;
9403
9404 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9405 leftBetter--;
9406 break;
9407
9408 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9409 break;
9410 }
9411 }
9412 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
9413 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
9414
9415 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9416 return false;
9417
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009418 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
9419 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9420 return true;
9421
9422 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9423 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedman1e7a0c62011-10-14 23:10:30 +00009424 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedmane2c600c2011-10-14 21:52:24 +00009425 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9426 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009427
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009428 // TODO: others?
9429 }
9430
9431 // Sort everything else by location.
9432 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9433 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9434
9435 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9436 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
9437 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
9438
9439 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009440 }
9441};
9442
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009443/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009444/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009445void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009446 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009447 assert(!Cand->Viable);
9448
9449 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
9450 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
9451
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009452 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
9453 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009454 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
9455 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009456
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009457 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009458 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009459 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009460 while (true) {
9461 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
9462 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009463 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009464 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009465 break;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009466 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009467 }
9468
9469 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
9470 return;
9471
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009472 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
9473 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
9474
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00009475 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009476 // operation somehow.
9477 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009478
9479 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
9480 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
9481
9482 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
9483 QualType ConvType
9484 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9485 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9486 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9487 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9488 ArgIdx--;
9489 } else if (Cand->Function) {
9490 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9491 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
9492 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
9493 ArgIdx--;
9494 } else {
9495 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
9496 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
9497 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
9498 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00009499 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
9500 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009501 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009502 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
9503 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009504 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009505 return;
9506 }
9507
9508 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00009509 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009510 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00009511 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00009512 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
9513 S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx), SuppressUserConversions,
9514 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9515 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
9516 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009517 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
9518 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009519 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009520 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009521 else
9522 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
9523 }
9524}
9525
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009526} // end anonymous namespace
9527
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009528/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
9529/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009530/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009531void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
9532 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009533 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie1d202a62012-10-08 01:11:04 +00009534 StringRef Opc,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009535 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009536 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
9537 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009538 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009539 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
9540 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009541 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009542 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009543 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009544 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009545 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
9546 Cands.push_back(Cand);
9547 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
9548 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009549 }
9550 }
9551
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009552 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009553 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, Args.size()));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009554
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009555 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009556
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009557 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregor79591782012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009558 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009559 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009560 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9561 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00009562
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009563 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
9564 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9565 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregor79591782012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009566 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009567 break;
9568 }
9569 ++CandsShown;
9570
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009571 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009572 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009573 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009574 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009575 else {
9576 assert(Cand->Viable &&
9577 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009578 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
9579 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
9580 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
9581 //
9582 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
9583 // different ambiguities, though.
9584 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009585 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009586 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
9587 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009588
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009589 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009590 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00009591 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009592 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009593
9594 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009595 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009596}
9597
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009598static SourceLocation
9599GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
9600 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
9601 : SourceLocation();
9602}
9603
9604struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
9605 Sema &S;
9606 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
9607
9608 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
9609 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
9610 // Fast-path this check.
9611 if (L == R)
9612 return false;
9613
9614 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
9615
9616 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
9617 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9618 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
9619 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9620
9621 // Sort everything else by location.
9622 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9623 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9624
9625 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9626 if (LLoc.isInvalid())
9627 return false;
9628 if (RLoc.isInvalid())
9629 return true;
9630
9631 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9632 }
9633};
9634
9635/// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
9636/// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
9637/// deductions.
9638void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S) {
9639 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Specialization, // pattern
9640 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0);
9641}
9642
9643void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
9644 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
9645 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
9646 }
9647}
9648
9649void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
9650 destroyCandidates();
9651 Candidates.clear();
9652}
9653
9654/// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
9655/// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
9656/// the candidate set.
9657/// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
9658/// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
9659void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
9660 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
9661 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
9662 // and sort those.
9663 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
9664 Cands.reserve(size());
9665 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9666 if (Cand->Specialization)
9667 Cands.push_back(Cand);
Alp Tokerd4733632013-12-05 04:47:09 +00009668 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not,
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009669 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9670 }
9671
9672 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9673 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
9674
9675 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
9676 // for generalization purposes (?).
9677 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9678
9679 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
9680 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9681 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9682 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
9683
9684 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
9685 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9686 // candidate list.
9687 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
9688 break;
9689 ++CandsShown;
9690
9691 assert(Cand->Specialization &&
9692 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9693 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S);
9694 }
9695
9696 if (I != E)
9697 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9698}
9699
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009700// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
9701// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9702// R (A) --> R(A)
9703// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9704// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9705// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9706QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9707 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9708 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9709 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9710 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9711 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9712 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9713 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009714 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009715 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9716 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9717 Ret =
9718 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9719 return Ret;
9720}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009721
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009722// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9723// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9724class AddressOfFunctionResolver
9725{
9726 Sema& S;
9727 Expr* SourceExpr;
9728 const QualType& TargetType;
9729 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9730
9731 bool Complain;
9732 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9733 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009734
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009735 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9736 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009737 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009738
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009739 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9740 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9741 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009742 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009743 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009744
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009745public:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009746 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
9747 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
9748 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9749 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9750 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9751 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9752 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009753 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009754 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9755 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
9756 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc()) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009757 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009758
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009759 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9760 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
9761 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
9762 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
9763 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
9764 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9765 DeclAccessPair dap;
9766 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9767 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
9768 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
9769 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9770 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
9771 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
9772 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9773 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009774
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009775 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9776 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9777 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9778 return;
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009779 }
9780
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009781 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009782 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009783 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009784 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009785
9786 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9787 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009788
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009789 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9790 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9791 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9792 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9793 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9794 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9795 else
9796 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9797 }
9798 }
9799 }
9800
9801private:
9802 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9803 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9804 }
9805
9806 // [ToType] [Return]
9807
9808 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9809 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9810 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9811 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9812 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9813 }
9814
9815 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9816 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9817 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9818 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9819 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9820 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9821 // static when converting to member pointer.
9822 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9823 return false;
9824 }
9825 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9826 return false;
9827
9828 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9829 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9830 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9831 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9832 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9833 // overloaded functions considered.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00009834 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009835 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009836 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9837 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9838 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9839 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009840 Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009841 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9842 FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
9843 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
9844 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009845 return false;
9846 }
9847
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009848 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
9849 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009850 // This function template specicalization works.
9851 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009852 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
9853 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
9854 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009855 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9856 return true;
9857 }
9858
9859 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9860 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009861 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009862 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9863 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009864 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9865 return false;
9866 }
9867 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9868 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009869
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009870 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009871 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009872 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9873 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9874 return false;
9875
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009876 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
9877 // now.
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00009878 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009879 FunDecl->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009880 S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain))
9881 return false;
9882
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009883 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009884 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9885 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009886 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9887 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009888 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9889 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009890 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009891 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009892 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009893 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009894
9895 return false;
9896 }
9897
9898 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9899 bool Ret = false;
9900
9901 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9902 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9903 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9904 return false;
9905
9906 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9907 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9908 I != E; ++I) {
9909 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9910 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9911
9912 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9913 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9914 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9915 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9916 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9917 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9918 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9919 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9920 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9921 Ret = true;
9922 }
9923 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9924 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9925 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9926 Ret = true;
9927 }
9928 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9929 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009930 }
9931
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009932 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009933 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9934 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9935 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9936 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9937 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9938
9939 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9940 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9941 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9942 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009943
9944 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9945 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9946 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009947
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009948 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
9949 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
9950 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
Richard Smith35e1da22013-09-10 22:59:25 +00009951 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009952 SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(),
9953 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) << Matches[0]
9954 .second->getDeclName(),
9955 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) << (unsigned)oc_function_template,
9956 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009957
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009958 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9959 // Make it the first and only element
9960 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9961 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9962 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009963 }
9964 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009965
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009966 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9967 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9968 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9969 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00009970 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009971 ++I;
9972 else {
9973 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9974 Matches.set_size(N);
9975 }
9976 }
9977 }
9978
9979public:
9980 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9981 assert(Matches.empty());
9982 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9983 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9984 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith0d905472013-08-14 00:00:44 +00009985 if (FailedCandidates.empty())
9986 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
9987 else {
9988 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
9989 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
9990 // normally.
9991 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9992 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9993 I != IEnd; ++I)
9994 if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
9995 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
9996 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, TargetFunctionType);
9997 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart());
9998 }
9999 }
10000
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010001 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
10002 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
10003 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
10004 }
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +000010005
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010006 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
10007 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
10008 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
10009 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
10010 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
10011 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10012 }
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +000010013
10014 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
10015 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
10016 }
10017
10018 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
10019 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(),
10020 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
10021 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10022 }
10023
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010024 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
10025 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
10026 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
10027 }
10028
10029 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
10030 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
10031 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10032 << OvlExpr->getName()
10033 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +000010034 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010035 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010036
10037 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
10038
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010039 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
10040
10041 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010042 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010043 return Matches[0].second;
10044 }
10045
10046 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010047 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010048 return &Matches[0].first;
10049 }
10050};
10051
10052/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
10053/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
10054/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
10055/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
10056///
10057/// @code
10058/// int f(double);
10059/// int f(int);
10060///
10061/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
10062/// @endcode
10063///
10064/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
10065/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
10066/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
10067FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010068Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
10069 QualType TargetType,
10070 bool Complain,
10071 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
10072 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010073 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010074
10075 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
10076 Complain);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010077 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010078 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010079 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010080 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
10081 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
10082 else
10083 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
10084 }
10085 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
10086 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
10087 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
10088 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
10089 assert(Fn);
10090 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +000010091 if (Complain) {
10092 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
10093 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
10094 else
10095 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
10096 }
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +000010097 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010098
10099 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
10100 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010101 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010102}
10103
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010104/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010105/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
10106///
10107/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
10108/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010109/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010110/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
Alp Toker67b47ac2013-10-20 18:48:56 +000010111///
10112/// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
10113/// returned.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010114FunctionDecl *
10115Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
10116 bool Complain,
10117 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010118 // C++ [over.over]p1:
10119 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
10120 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010121 // C++ [over.over]p1:
10122 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
10123 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010124
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010125 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010126 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010127 return nullptr;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +000010128
10129 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010130 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +000010131 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010132
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010133 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
10134 // whose type matches exactly.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010135 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010136 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
10137 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010138 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
10139 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010140 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
10141 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
10142 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010143 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +000010144 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
10145 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010146
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010147 // C++ [over.over]p2:
10148 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
10149 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
10150 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
10151 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
10152 // overloaded functions considered.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010153 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +000010154 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010155 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
10156 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +000010157 Specialization, Info,
10158 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +000010159 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
10160 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
10161 FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
10162 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
10163 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010164 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010165 }
10166
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010167 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
10168
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010169 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010170 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010171 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010172 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10173 << ovl->getName();
10174 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010175 }
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010176 return nullptr;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010177 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010178
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010179 Matched = Specialization;
10180 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010181 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010182
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +000010183 if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000010184 Matched->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +000010185 DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010186 return nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +000010187
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010188 return Matched;
10189}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010190
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010191
10192
10193
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010194// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
10195// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
10196//
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010197// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010198//
10199// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
10200// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
10201// returns true if 'complain' is set.
10202bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10203 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
10204 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010205 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010206 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010207 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010208
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010209 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010210
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010211 DeclAccessPair found;
10212 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
10213 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10214 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010215 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010216 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10217 return true;
10218 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010219
10220 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
10221 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
10222 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
10223 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
10224 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
10225 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
10226 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010227 if (!complain) return false;
10228
10229 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
10230 diag::err_bound_member_function)
10231 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
10232
10233 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
10234 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
10235 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
10236 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
10237 // the static candidates were rejected.
10238 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10239 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010240 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +000010241
Sylvestre Ledrua5202662012-07-31 06:56:50 +000010242 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010243 SingleFunctionExpression =
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010244 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010245
10246 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010247 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010248 SingleFunctionExpression =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010249 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010250 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
10251 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10252 return true;
10253 }
10254 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010255 }
10256
10257 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
10258 if (complain) {
10259 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
10260 << ovl.Expression->getName()
10261 << DestTypeForComplaining
10262 << OpRangeForComplaining
10263 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010264 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
10265
10266 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10267 return true;
10268 }
10269
10270 return false;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010271 }
10272
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010273 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
10274 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010275}
10276
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010277/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
10278static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010279 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +000010280 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010281 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010282 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010283 bool PartialOverloading,
10284 bool KnownValid) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010285 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010286 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
10287 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
10288
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010289 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010290 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
10291 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
10292 return;
10293 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010294 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
10295 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010296 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010297 }
10298
10299 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
10300 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010301 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010302 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010303 return;
10304 }
10305
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010306 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010307}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010308
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010309/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
10310/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010311void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010312 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010313 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10314 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010315
10316#ifndef NDEBUG
10317 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
10318 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010319 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010320 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
10321 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
10322 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
10323 //
10324 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
10325 //
10326 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010327 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010328 //
10329 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
10330 // template
10331 //
10332 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010333
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010334 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10335 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10336 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10337 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
10338 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
10339 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
10340 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010341 }
10342 }
10343#endif
10344
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010345 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
10346 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010347 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010348 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10349 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10350 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10351 }
10352
10353 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10354 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010355 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10356 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
10357 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010358
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010359 if (ULE->requiresADL())
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010360 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010361 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010362 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010363}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010364
Richard Smith0603bbb2013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010365/// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
10366/// a different namespace.
10367static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
10368 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
10369 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
10370 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
10371 return false;
10372
10373 default:
10374 return true;
10375 }
10376}
10377
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010378/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
10379/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
10380/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
10381/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
10382///
10383/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10384static bool
10385DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
10386 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010387 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010388 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010389 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010390 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
10391 return false;
10392
10393 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewyckyfcd5e7a2012-03-14 20:41:00 +000010394 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
10395 continue;
10396
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010397 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
10398
10399 if (!R.empty()) {
10400 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10401
10402 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
10403 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
10404 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
10405 R.clear();
10406 return false;
10407 }
10408
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010409 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010410 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
10411 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010412 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010413 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010414
10415 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010416 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010417 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
10418 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010419 R.clear();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010420 return false;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010421 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010422
10423 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
10424 // declaring the function there instead.
10425 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
10426 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall7d8b0412012-08-24 20:38:34 +000010427 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010428 AssociatedNamespaces,
10429 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010430 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smith0603bbb2013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010431 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
10432 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
10433 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
10434 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
10435 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
10436 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
10437 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
10438 continue;
Richard Smith21bae432012-12-22 02:46:14 +000010439
Richard Smith0603bbb2013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010440 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
10441 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
10442 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
10443 if (NS &&
10444 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
10445 continue;
10446
10447 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
10448 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010449 }
10450
10451 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10452 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010453 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010454 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10455 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10456 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010457 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010458 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10459 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010460 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010461 } else {
10462 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
10463 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
10464 // a localized representation of a list of items.
10465 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10466 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10467 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
10468 }
10469
10470 // Try to recover by calling this function.
10471 return true;
10472 }
10473
10474 R.clear();
10475 }
10476
10477 return false;
10478}
10479
10480/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
10481/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
10482/// was defined.
10483///
10484/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10485static bool
10486DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
10487 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010488 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010489 DeclarationName OpName =
10490 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10491 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
10492 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010493 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010494 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010495}
10496
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +000010497namespace {
Richard Smith88d67f32012-09-25 04:46:05 +000010498class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
10499 Sema &SemaRef;
10500public:
10501 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
10502 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
10503 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
10504 }
10505
10506 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
10507 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
10508 }
10509};
10510
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +000010511}
10512
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010513/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
10514///
10515/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010516static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +000010517BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010518 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10519 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Craig Toppere3d2ecbe2014-06-28 23:22:33 +000010520 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010521 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010522 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smith88d67f32012-09-25 04:46:05 +000010523 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
10524 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
10525 //
10526 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
10527 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
10528 //
10529 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
10530 return ExprError();
10531 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010532
10533 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010534 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010535 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010536
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010537 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010538 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010539 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10540 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10541 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10542 }
10543
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010544 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
10545 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Kaelyn Uhrain53e72192013-07-08 23:13:39 +000010546 FunctionCallFilterCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010547 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
Kaelyn Takatafb271f02014-04-04 22:16:30 +000010548 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010549 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
10550 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
10551 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
10552 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010553 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010554 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010555 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010556 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010557 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010558 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010559 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010560
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010561 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
10562
10563 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
10564 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010565 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010566 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010567 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
10568 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010569 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010570 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010571 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010572 else
10573 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
10574
10575 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010576 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010577
10578 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010579 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010580 // end up here.
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010581 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010582 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
10583 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010584}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +000010585
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010586/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10587/// the given function.
10588/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10589bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10590 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010591 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010592 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10593 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10594 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010595#ifndef NDEBUG
10596 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10597 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
10598 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
10599
10600 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
10601 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
10602 FunctionDecl *F;
10603 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
10604 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
10605 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +000010606 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010607
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010608 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010609 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010610 }
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010611#endif
10612
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010613 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010614 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010615 *Result = ExprError();
10616 return true;
10617 }
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +000010618
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010619 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
10620 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010621 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010622
10623 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010624 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
10625 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010626 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010627 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
10628 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010629 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010630 // classes.
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +000010631 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetde232cb2011-11-25 01:10:54 +000010632 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010633 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args,
Benjamin Kramerc215e762012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010634 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10635 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010636 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010637 *Result = CE;
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010638 return true;
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010639 }
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010640 return false;
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010641 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010642
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010643 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010644 return false;
10645}
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010646
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010647/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
10648/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
10649/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
10650static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10651 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10652 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010653 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010654 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10655 Expr *ExecConfig,
10656 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10657 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
10658 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
10659 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10660 if (CandidateSet->empty())
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010661 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010662 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
10663 AllowTypoCorrection);
10664
10665 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010666 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010667 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010668 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000010669 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
10670 return ExprError();
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010671 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010672 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10673 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010674 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010675
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010676 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10677 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
10678 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010679 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010680 Args, RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010681 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
10682 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010683 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
10684 return Recovery;
10685
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010686 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010687 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010688 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010689 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010690 break;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010691 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010692
10693 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010694 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010695 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010696 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010697 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010698
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010699 case OR_Deleted: {
10700 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
10701 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
10702 << ULE->getName()
10703 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
10704 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010705 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3eaa22a2011-11-04 15:58:13 +000010706
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010707 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
10708 // the call in the AST.
10709 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10710 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010711 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10712 ExecConfig);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010713 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010714 }
10715
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010716 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010717 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010718}
10719
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010720/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10721/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10722/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10723/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10724/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10725/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10726ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10727 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10728 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010729 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010730 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10731 Expr *ExecConfig,
10732 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010733 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
10734 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010735 ExprResult result;
10736
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010737 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
10738 &result))
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010739 return result;
10740
10741 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10742 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
10743 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
10744
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010745 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010746 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10747 &Best, OverloadResult,
10748 AllowTypoCorrection);
10749}
10750
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010751static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010752 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10753 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10754}
10755
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010756/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10757/// operator.
10758///
10759/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10760///
10761/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10762/// operator.
10763///
James Dennett18348b62012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010764/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010765/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10766/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10767/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10768/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10769/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10770///
James Dennett91738ff2012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010771/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010772ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010773Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10774 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010775 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010776 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010777
10778 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10779 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10780 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010781 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10782 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010783
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010784 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10785 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010786
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010787 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010788 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010789
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010790 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10791 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10792 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010793 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010794 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010795 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10796 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010797 NumArgs = 2;
10798 }
10799
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010800 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
10801
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010802 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010803 if (Fns.empty())
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010804 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
10805 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010806
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010807 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010808 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010809 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010810 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010811 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10812 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010813 return new (Context)
10814 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy,
10815 VK_RValue, OpLoc, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010816 }
10817
10818 // Build an empty overload set.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010819 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010820
10821 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010822 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010823
10824 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010825 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010826
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010827 // Add candidates from ADL.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010828 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010829 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
10830 CandidateSet);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010831
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010832 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010833 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010834
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010835 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10836
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010837 // Perform overload resolution.
10838 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010839 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010840 case OR_Success: {
10841 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10842 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010843
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010844 if (FnDecl) {
10845 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10846 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010847
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010848 // Convert the arguments.
10849 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010850 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010851
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010852 ExprResult InputRes =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010853 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010854 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10855 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010856 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010857 Input = InputRes.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010858 } else {
10859 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010860 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010861 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010862 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010863 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010864 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010865 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010866 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010867 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010868 Input = InputInit.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010869 }
10870
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010871 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010872 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010873 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010874 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10875 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010876
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000010877 // Determine the result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000010878 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000010879 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10880 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10881
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010882 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010883 CallExpr *TheCall =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010884 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray,
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010885 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010886
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000010887 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010888 return ExprError();
10889
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010890 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010891 } else {
10892 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10893 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10894 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010895 ExprResult InputRes =
10896 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10897 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10898 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10899 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010900 Input = InputRes.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010901 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010902 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010903 }
10904
10905 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010906 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10907 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10908 // defined too late to be candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010909 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010910 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10911 return ExprError();
10912
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010913 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10914 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10915 break;
10916
10917 case OR_Ambiguous:
10918 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10919 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10920 << Input->getType()
10921 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010922 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010923 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10924 return ExprError();
10925
10926 case OR_Deleted:
10927 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10928 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10929 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10930 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10931 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010932 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010933 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010934 return ExprError();
10935 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010936
10937 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10938 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10939 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010940 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010941}
10942
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010943/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10944/// operator.
10945///
10946/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10947///
10948/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10949/// operator.
10950///
James Dennett18348b62012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010951/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010952/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10953/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10954/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10955/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10956/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10957///
10958/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10959/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010960ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010961Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010962 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010963 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010964 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010965 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010966 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010967
10968 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10969 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10970 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10971
10972 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10973 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010974 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010975 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010976 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010977 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010978 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010979 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(
10980 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10981 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010982
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010983 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
10984 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
10985 Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc,
10986 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010987 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010988
10989 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010990 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010991 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10992 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010993 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010994 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10995 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10996 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010997 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010998 return new (Context)
10999 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy,
11000 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011001 }
11002
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011003 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
11004 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11005 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011006
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +000011007 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
11008 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
11009 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011010 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11011 return ExprError();
11012
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +000011013 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
11014 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
11015 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
11016 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
11017 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
11018 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011019 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011020 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011021
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011022 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
11023 // create a built-in binary operator.
11024 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
11025 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11026
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000011027 // Build an empty overload set.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011028 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011029
11030 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011031 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011032
11033 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011034 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011035
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000011036 // Add candidates from ADL.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011037 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011038 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000011039 CandidateSet);
11040
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011041 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011042 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011043
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011044 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11045
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011046 // Perform overload resolution.
11047 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011048 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +000011049 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011050 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11051 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11052
11053 if (FnDecl) {
11054 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11055 // operator.
11056
11057 // Convert the arguments.
11058 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +000011059 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011060 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +000011061
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011062 ExprResult Arg1 =
11063 PerformCopyInitialization(
11064 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11065 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011066 SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011067 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011068 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011069
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011070 ExprResult Arg0 =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011071 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011072 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11073 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011074 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011075 Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11076 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011077 } else {
11078 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011079 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
11080 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11081 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011082 SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011083 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011084 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011085
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011086 ExprResult Arg1 =
11087 PerformCopyInitialization(
11088 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11089 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011090 SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011091 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
11092 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011093 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11094 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011095 }
11096
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011097 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011098 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011099 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011100 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011101 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11102 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011103
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011104 // Determine the result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011105 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011106 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11107 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11108
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011109 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011110 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(),
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011111 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
11112 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011113
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011114 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011115 FnDecl))
11116 return ExprError();
11117
Nick Lewyckyd24d5f22013-01-24 02:03:08 +000011118 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
11119 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
11120 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
11121 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
11122 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
11123 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
11124
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011125 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011126 } else {
11127 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11128 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11129 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011130 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11131 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11132 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11133 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011134 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011135 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011136
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011137 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11138 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11139 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11140 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11141 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011142 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011143 break;
11144 }
11145 }
11146
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011147 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11148 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
11149 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
11150 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
11151 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011152 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011153 break;
11154
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011155 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
11156 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
11157 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011158 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011159 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011160 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000011161 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
11162 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011163 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmana31efa02013-08-28 20:35:35 +000011164 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
11165 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
11166 << Args[0]->getType()
11167 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11168 }
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011169 } else {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000011170 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
11171 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
11172 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011173 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000011174 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
11175 return ExprError();
11176
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011177 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
11178 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
11179 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000011180 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011181 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011182 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
11183 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011184 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011185 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer62b95d82012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011186 return Result;
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011187 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011188
11189 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011190 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011191 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011192 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011193 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011194 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011195 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011196 return ExprError();
11197
11198 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregor74f7d502012-02-15 19:33:52 +000011199 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
11200 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11201 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smithde1a4872012-12-28 12:23:24 +000011202 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
11203 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith6f1e2c62012-04-02 20:59:25 +000011204
Richard Smithde1a4872012-12-28 12:23:24 +000011205 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
11206 // explain why it's deleted.
11207 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
11208 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor74f7d502012-02-15 19:33:52 +000011209 } else {
11210 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11211 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11212 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11213 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11214 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11215 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011216 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +000011217 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011218 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +000011219 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011220
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011221 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011222 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011223}
11224
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011225ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011226Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
11227 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011228 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
11229 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011230 DeclarationName OpName =
11231 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
11232
11233 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
11234 // expression.
11235 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
11236
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011237 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000011238 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
11239 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11240 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011241 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000011242 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011243 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000011244 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
11245 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
11246 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011247 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011248
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011249 return new (Context)
11250 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args,
11251 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, false);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011252 }
11253
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011254 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
11255 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11256 return ExprError();
11257 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11258 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011259
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011260 // Build an empty overload set.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011261 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011262
11263 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
11264
11265 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011266 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011267
11268 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011269 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011270
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011271 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11272
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011273 // Perform overload resolution.
11274 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011275 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011276 case OR_Success: {
11277 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11278 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11279
11280 if (FnDecl) {
11281 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11282 // operator.
11283
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011284 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +000011285
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011286 // Convert the arguments.
11287 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011288 ExprResult Arg0 =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011289 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011290 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11291 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011292 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011293 Args[0] = Arg0.get();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011294
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011295 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011296 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011297 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011298 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011299 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011300 SourceLocation(),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011301 Args[1]);
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011302 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11303 return ExprError();
11304
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011305 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011306
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011307 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011308 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11309 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011310 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011311 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011312 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011313 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11314 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011315 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11316 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011317
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011318 // Determine the result type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011319 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011320 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11321 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11322
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011323 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11324 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011325 FnExpr.get(), Args,
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011326 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
11327 false);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011328
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011329 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011330 return ExprError();
11331
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011332 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011333 } else {
11334 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11335 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11336 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011337 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11338 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11339 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11340 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011341 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011342 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011343
11344 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11345 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11346 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11347 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11348 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011349 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011350
11351 break;
11352 }
11353 }
11354
11355 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011356 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11357 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
11358 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
11359 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11360 else
11361 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
11362 << Args[0]->getType()
11363 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011364 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011365 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011366 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011367 }
11368
11369 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011370 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011371 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011372 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11373 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011374 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011375 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011376 return ExprError();
11377
11378 case OR_Deleted:
11379 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11380 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011381 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011382 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011383 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011384 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011385 return ExprError();
11386 }
11387
11388 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011389 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011390}
11391
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011392/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
11393/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
11394/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
11395/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
11396/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011397/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
11398/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011399ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011400Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011401 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11402 MultiExprArg Args,
11403 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011404 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
11405 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11406
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011407 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
11408 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011409 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011410
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011411 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
11412 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11413 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
11414 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
11415
11416 QualType fnType =
11417 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11418
11419 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11420 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011421 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011422
11423 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
11424 // member function we're calling.
11425 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
11426
11427 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
11428 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
11429 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11430 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
11431
11432 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
11433 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
11434 difference.removeAddressSpace();
11435 if (difference) {
11436 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
11437 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
11438 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
11439 << qualsString
11440 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
11441 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +000011442
David Majnemerb3e56542014-08-07 22:56:13 +000011443 if (resultType->isMemberPointerType())
11444 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
11445 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, resultType, 0);
11446
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011447 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011448 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011449 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
11450
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011451 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011452 call, nullptr))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011453 return ExprError();
11454
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011455 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011456 return ExprError();
11457
Richard Trieu9be9c682013-06-22 02:30:38 +000011458 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
11459 return ExprError();
11460
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011461 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
11462 }
11463
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011464 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011465 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011466 return ExprError();
11467
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011468 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011469 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
11470 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
11471 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011472 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11473 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011474 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011475 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011476 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011477 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011478 } else {
11479 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011480 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011481
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011482 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011483 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
11484 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
11485 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011486
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011487 // Add overload candidates
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011488 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11489 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011490
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011491 // FIXME: avoid copy.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011492 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011493 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11494 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11495 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11496 }
11497
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011498 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
11499 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11500
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011501 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
11502 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
11503 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
11504 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
11505
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011506
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000011507 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +000011508 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011509 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011510 Args, CandidateSet);
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000011511 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000011512 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
11513 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011514 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000011515 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011516
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011517 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011518 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011519 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011520 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011521 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011522 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011523 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011524 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000011525 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011526 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000011527 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011528
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011529 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
11530
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011531 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11532
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011533 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011534 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +000011535 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011536 case OR_Success:
11537 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011538 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011539 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011540 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11541 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid6676412013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011542 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
11543 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
11544 // called on both.
11545 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
11546 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
11547 // being used.
11548 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11549 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11550 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011551 break;
11552
11553 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011554 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011555 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011556 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011557 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011558 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011559 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011560
11561 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011562 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011563 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011564 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011565 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011566 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011567
11568 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011569 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011570 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011571 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011572 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011573 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011574 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011575 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011576 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011577 }
11578
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011579 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011580
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011581 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
11582 // non-member call based on that function.
11583 if (Method->isStatic()) {
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011584 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
11585 RParenLoc);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011586 }
11587
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011588 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011589 }
11590
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011591 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011592 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
11593 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11594
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011595 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011596 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011597 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011598 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011599
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +000011600 // Check for a valid return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011601 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011602 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011603 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011604
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011605 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011606 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
11607 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011608 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11609 ExprResult ObjectArg =
11610 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
11611 FoundDecl, Method);
11612 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
11613 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011614 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011615 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011616
11617 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011618 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11619 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011620 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011621 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011622 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011623
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011624 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011625
Richard Smith55ce3522012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011626 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011627 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +000011628
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011629 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
11630 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
11631 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
11632 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
11633
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011634 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011635 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
11636 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
11637 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
11638 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
11639
11640 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011641 }
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011642 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011643 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011644}
11645
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011646/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
11647/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
11648/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
11649/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000011650ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011651Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +000011652 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011653 MultiExprArg Args,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011654 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011655 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
11656 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011657 ExprResult Object = Obj;
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011658
11659 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011660 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011661 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011662
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011663 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
11664 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011665
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011666 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
11667 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +000011668 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011669 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
11670 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
11671 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
11672 // (E).operator().
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011673 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
11674 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000011675 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011676
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011677 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011678 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011679 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011680
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011681 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11682 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
11683 R.suppressDiagnostics();
11684
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011685 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011686 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011687 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011688 Object.get()->Classify(Context),
11689 Args, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +000011690 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011691 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011692
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011693 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011694 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
11695 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011696 //
11697 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
11698 //
11699 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
11700 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +000011701 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
11702 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
11703 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
11704 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011705 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
11706 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
11707 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
11708 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
11709 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011710 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
11711 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +000011712 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011713 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
11714 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011715 NamedDecl *D = *I;
11716 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
11717 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
11718 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011719
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011720 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
11721 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011722 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011723 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +000011724
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011725 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011726 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
11727 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
11728 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
11729 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11730 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11731 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011732
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011733 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11734 {
11735 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011736 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011737 }
11738 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011739 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011740
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011741 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11742
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011743 // Perform overload resolution.
11744 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011745 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011746 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011747 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011748 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11749 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011750 break;
11751
11752 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011753 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011754 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011755 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11756 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011757 else
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011758 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011759 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011760 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011761 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011762 break;
11763
11764 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011765 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011766 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011767 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011768 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011769 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011770
11771 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011772 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011773 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11774 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011775 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011776 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011777 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011778 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011779 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011780 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011781
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011782 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011783 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011784
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011785 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11786
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011787 if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011788 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11789 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011790 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011791 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11792 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11793
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011794 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
11795 Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011796 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
11797 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid6676412013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011798 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11799 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011800 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11801 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11802 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011803
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011804 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011805 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011806 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11807 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011808 if (Call.isInvalid())
11809 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011810 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011811 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11812 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
11813 nullptr, VK_RValue);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011814
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011815 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011816 }
11817
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011818 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011819
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011820 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11821 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11822 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11823 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Weber1fefe412012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011824
11825 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber9512d3f2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011826 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Weber1fefe412012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011827 return ExprError();
11828
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011829 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11830 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011831
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011832 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011833
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011834 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11835 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11836 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011837 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011838 HadMultipleCandidates,
11839 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11840 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011841 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11842 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011843
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011844 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
11845 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
Ahmed Charlesaf94d562014-03-09 11:34:25 +000011846 std::unique_ptr<Expr * []> MethodArgs(new Expr *[Args.size() + 1]);
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011847 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
11848 std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), &MethodArgs[1]);
11849
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011850 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11851 // owned.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011852 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011853 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11854 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11855
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011856 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context)
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011857 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(),
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011858 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs.get(), Args.size() + 1),
11859 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
11860 MethodArgs.reset();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011861
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011862 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011863 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011864
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011865 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11866 // slots in the call for them.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011867 if (Args.size() < NumParams)
11868 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011869
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011870 bool IsError = false;
11871
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011872 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011873 ExprResult ObjRes =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011874 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011875 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11876 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11877 IsError = true;
11878 else
Benjamin Kramer62b95d82012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011879 Object = ObjRes;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011880 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011881
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011882 // Check the argument types.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011883 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011884 Expr *Arg;
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011885 if (i < Args.size()) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011886 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011887
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011888 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011889
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011890 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011891 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011892 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011893 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011894 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011895
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011896 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011897 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011898 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011899 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011900 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11901 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11902 IsError = true;
11903 break;
11904 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011905
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011906 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011907 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011908
11909 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11910 }
11911
11912 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11913 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11914 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011915 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011916 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
11917 nullptr);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011918 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011919 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011920 }
11921 }
11922
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011923 if (IsError) return true;
11924
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011925 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011926
Richard Smith55ce3522012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011927 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011928 return true;
11929
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011930 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011931}
11932
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011933/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011934/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011935/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011936ExprResult
Kaelyn Uhrain0c51de42013-07-31 17:38:24 +000011937Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11938 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011939 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11940 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011941
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011942 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11943 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011944
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011945 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11946
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011947 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11948 //
11949 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11950 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11951 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11952 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011953 DeclarationName OpName =
11954 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011955 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011956 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011957
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011958 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011959 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011960 return ExprError();
11961
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011962 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11963 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11964 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011965
11966 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011967 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011968 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
Dmitri Gribenko44ebbd52013-05-05 00:41:58 +000011969 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011970 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011971
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011972 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11973
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011974 // Perform overload resolution.
11975 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011976 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011977 case OR_Success:
11978 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11979 break;
11980
11981 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011982 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
11983 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
Kaelyn Uhrain0c51de42013-07-31 17:38:24 +000011984 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
11985 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
11986 // diagnostic, as requested.
11987 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
11988 return ExprError();
11989 }
Kaelyn Uhrainbad7fb02013-07-15 19:54:54 +000011990 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
11991 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011992 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrainbad7fb02013-07-15 19:54:54 +000011993 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011994 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011995 }
11996 } else
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011997 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011998 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011999 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012000 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012001
12002 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000012003 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
12004 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000012005 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012006 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000012007
12008 case OR_Deleted:
12009 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
12010 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000012011 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000012012 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000012013 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000012014 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012015 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012016 }
12017
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012018 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000012019
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012020 // Convert the object parameter.
12021 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000012022 ExprResult BaseResult =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012023 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000012024 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12025 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012026 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012027 Base = BaseResult.get();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +000012028
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012029 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000012030 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000012031 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000012032 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
12033 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012034
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012035 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012036 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12037 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000012038 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012039 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(),
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000012040 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000012041
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012042 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000012043 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +000012044
12045 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012046}
12047
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012048/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
12049/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
12050ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
12051 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
12052 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
12053 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
12054 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
12055 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012056
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000012057 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
12058 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012059 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
12060 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012061
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012062 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12063
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012064 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
12065 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
12066 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12067 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
12068 case OR_Success:
12069 case OR_Deleted:
12070 break;
12071
12072 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12073 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
12074 << R.getLookupName();
12075 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12076 return ExprError();
12077
12078 case OR_Ambiguous:
12079 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
12080 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
12081 return ExprError();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012082 }
12083
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012084 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000012085 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
12086 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012087 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
12088 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
12089 if (Fn.isInvalid())
12090 return true;
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012091
12092 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
12093 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012094 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000012095 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012096 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
12097 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
12098 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
12099 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
12100 return true;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012101 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012102 }
12103
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012104 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012105 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12106 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12107
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012108 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012109 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(),
Benjamin Kramerc215e762012-08-24 11:54:20 +000012110 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012111 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
12112
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012113 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012114 return ExprError();
12115
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012116 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012117 return ExprError();
12118
12119 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
12120}
12121
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012122/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
12123/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
12124/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
12125/// dependent lookup.
12126/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
12127/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
12128/// is returned.
12129Sema::ForRangeStatus
12130Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
12131 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
12132 BeginEndFunction BEF,
12133 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
12134 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
12135 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12136 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
12137 CandidateSet->clear();
12138 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
12139 ExprResult MemberRef =
12140 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
12141 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
12142 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012143 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012144 MemberLookup,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012145 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012146 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
12147 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12148 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12149 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12150 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12151 }
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012152 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012153 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
12154 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12155 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12156 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12157 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12158 }
12159 } else {
12160 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012161 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012162 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012163 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
12164 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +000012165 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012166
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000012167 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012168 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
12169 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
12170 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12171 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12172 }
12173 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12174 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
12175 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
12176
12177 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12178 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12179 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12180 }
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000012181 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012182 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012183 OverloadResult,
12184 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
12185 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
12186 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12187 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12188 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12189 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12190 }
12191 }
12192 return FRS_Success;
12193}
12194
12195
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012196/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
12197/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
12198/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
12199/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +000012200/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +000012201Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012202 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012203 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012204 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
12205 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012206 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012207 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012208
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012209 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012210 }
12211
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012212 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012213 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
12214 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012215 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012216 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +000012217 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000012218 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012219 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012220 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012221
12222 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000012223 ICE->getCastKind(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012224 SubExpr, nullptr,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000012225 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012226 }
12227
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012228 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000012229 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012230 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000012231 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12232 if (Method->isStatic()) {
12233 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
12234 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012235 } else {
Alp Toker028ed912013-12-06 17:56:43 +000012236 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000012237 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
12238 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012239 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12240 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012241 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012242 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012243
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012244 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
12245 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
12246 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
12247 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
12248
12249 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
12250 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
12251 // appropriate pointer to member type.
12252 QualType ClassType
12253 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
12254 QualType MemPtrType
12255 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
12256
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012257 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
12258 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12259 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000012260 }
12261 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012262 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12263 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012264 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012265 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012266
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000012267 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012268 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012269 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012270 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012271 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012272
12273 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012274 // FIXME: avoid copy.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012275 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000012276 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012277 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12278 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000012279 }
12280
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012281 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12282 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000012283 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012284 Fn,
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +000012285 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012286 ULE->getNameLoc(),
12287 Fn->getType(),
12288 VK_LValue,
12289 Found.getDecl(),
12290 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +000012291 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012292 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
12293 return DRE;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012294 }
12295
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000012296 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000012297 // FIXME: avoid copy.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012298 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012299 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12300 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12301 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12302 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000012303
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012304 Expr *Base;
12305
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012306 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
12307 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012308 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
12309 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012310 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12311 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000012312 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012313 Fn,
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +000012314 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012315 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12316 Fn->getType(),
12317 VK_LValue,
12318 Found.getDecl(),
12319 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +000012320 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012321 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
12322 return DRE;
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000012323 } else {
12324 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
12325 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000012326 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman73a04092012-01-07 04:59:52 +000012327 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000012328 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
12329 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
12330 /*isImplicit=*/true);
12331 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012332 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012333 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012334
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +000012335 ExprValueKind valueKind;
12336 QualType type;
12337 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
12338 valueKind = VK_LValue;
12339 type = Fn->getType();
12340 } else {
12341 valueKind = VK_RValue;
12342 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
12343 }
12344
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012345 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
12346 MemExpr->isArrow(),
12347 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000012348 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012349 Fn,
12350 Found,
12351 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
12352 TemplateArgs,
12353 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
12354 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4f6a2c42012-11-14 07:06:31 +000012355 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012356 return ME;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012357 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012358
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012359 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012360}
12361
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012362ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000012363 DeclAccessPair Found,
12364 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000012365 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +000012366}
12367
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000012368} // end namespace clang